blob: b01129f8f23d711559709dd9618c4e7e02def6f5 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Christopher Faulet05f01882020-09-25 18:40:47 +02007 2020/09/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
479list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
480arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
481before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
483 Example:
484
485 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
486
487 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
488
489 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
492file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
495 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
496
497* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
498 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
499 directory.
500
501* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 processes, separated by semicolons.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 CLI, separated by semicolons.
508
509See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200510
5112.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200512----------------
513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100514Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100515values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
516otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
517numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
518for every keyword. Supported units are :
519
520 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
521 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
522 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
523 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
524 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
525 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
526
527
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005282.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200529-------------
530
531 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
532 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
533 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
534 global
535 daemon
536 maxconn 256
537
538 defaults
539 mode http
540 timeout connect 5000ms
541 timeout client 50000ms
542 timeout server 50000ms
543
544 frontend http-in
545 bind *:80
546 default_backend servers
547
548 backend servers
549 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
550
551
552 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
553 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
554 global
555 daemon
556 maxconn 256
557
558 defaults
559 mode http
560 timeout connect 5000ms
561 timeout client 50000ms
562 timeout server 50000ms
563
564 listen http-in
565 bind *:80
566 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
567
568
569Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
570
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100571 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200572
573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005743. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575--------------------
576
577Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
578are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
579of them have command-line equivalents.
580
581The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
582
583 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200584 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - description
590 - deviceatlas-json-file
591 - deviceatlas-log-level
592 - deviceatlas-separator
593 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900594 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 - gid
596 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100597 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200598 - h1-case-adjust
599 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100600 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100601 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100602 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200603 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100608 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200609 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200611 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200612 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200614 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200675 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200682 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100683 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100685 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.session-timeout
687 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200688 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100689 - tune.maxaccept
690 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200691 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200692 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200693 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200694 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
695 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.rcvbuf.client
697 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100698 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200699 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200700 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100701 - tune.sndbuf.client
702 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100703 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200704 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100705 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200706 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100707 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200708 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200709 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100710 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200711 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100712 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200713 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
714 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
715 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100716 - tune.zlib.memlevel
717 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100718
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719 * Debugging
720 - debug
721 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200722 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723
724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007253.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200726------------------------------------
727
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200728ca-base <dir>
729 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100730 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
731 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
732 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200734chroot <jail dir>
735 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
736 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
737 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
738 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
739 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100740 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100741
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
743 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
744 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
745 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
746 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
747 set. These sets have the format
748
749 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
750
751 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
754 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100755 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
756 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100757 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100758 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100760 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100761 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
762 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
763 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
764 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100765
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100766 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
767 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
768 on the machine's word size.
769
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100770 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100771 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
772 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
773 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
774 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
775 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
776 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100777
778 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100779 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
780
781 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
782 # first 4 CPUs
783
784 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
785 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
786 # word size.
787
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100788 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100789 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100790 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
791 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
792 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
793
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100794 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
795 # and so on.
796 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
797 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
798 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
799
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100800 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100801 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
802 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
803 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
804
805 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
806 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
808
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100809 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
810 # and a thread range.
811 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
812 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
813 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
814
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200815crt-base <dir>
816 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100817 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
818 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200819
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820daemon
821 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
822 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100823 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
824 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826deviceatlas-json-file <path>
827 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200829
830deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100831 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200832 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
833
834deviceatlas-separator <char>
835 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
836 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
837
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100838deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200839 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
840 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
841 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100842
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900843external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100844 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
845 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100846 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
847 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
848 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
849 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
850 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900851
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852gid <number>
853 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
854 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
855 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100856 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
857 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200858 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100859
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100860group <group name>
861 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
862 See also "gid" and "user".
863
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100864hard-stop-after <time>
865 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
866
867 Arguments :
868 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
869 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
870 SIGUSR1 signal.
871
872 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
873 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
874 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
875
876 Example:
877 global
878 hard-stop-after 30s
879
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200880h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
881 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
882 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
883 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
884 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500885 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200886 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
887 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
888 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
889 specified in a proxy.
890
891 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
892 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
893 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
894 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
895 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
896 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
897 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
898
899 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
900 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
901 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
902 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
903 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
904
905 Example:
906 global
907 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
908
909 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
910 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
911
912h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
913 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
914 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
915 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
916 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
917 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
918 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
919 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
920 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
921
922 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
923 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
924 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
925
926 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
927 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
928
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100929insecure-fork-wanted
930 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
931 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
932 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
933 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
934 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
935 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
936 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
937 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
938 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
939 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
940 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
941 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
942 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
943 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
944 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
945 disable it.
946
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100947insecure-setuid-wanted
948 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
949 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
950 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
951 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
952 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
953 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
954 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
955 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
956 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
957 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
958 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
959 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
960 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
961 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
962
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100963issuers-chain-path <dir>
964 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
965 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
966 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
967 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
968 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
969 "issuers-chain-path".
970 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
971 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
972 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
973 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
974 will share the chain in memory.
975
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200976localpeer <name>
977 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
978 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
979 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
980 the configuration parsing.
981
982 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
983 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
984
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200985log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
986 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100987 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100989 configured with "log global".
990
991 <address> can be one of:
992
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100993 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100994 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
995 port).
996
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100997 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
998 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
999 port).
1000
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001001 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1003 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001004 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001005
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001006 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1007 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1008 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1009 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1010 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1011 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1012 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1013 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1014 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1015 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1016 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1017 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1018 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1019 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001020 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1021 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001022
1023 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1024 "fd@2", see above.
1025
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001026 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1027 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1028 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1029 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1030 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1031
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001032 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1033 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001034
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001035 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1036 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1037 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1038 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1039 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1040 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1041 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1042 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1043 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1044 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001045 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1046 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001047
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001048 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1049 one of the following :
1050
1051 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1053
1054 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1055 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1056
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001057 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1058 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1059 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1060 designed to be used with a local log server.
1061
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001062 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1063 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1064 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1065 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1066 logger consumes.
1067
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001068 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1069 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1070 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1071 used with a local log server.
1072
1073 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1074 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1075 designed to be used with a local log server.
1076
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001077 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1078 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1079 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1080 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1081
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001082 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1083 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1084 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1085 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1086 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1087
1088 <sample_size>
1089 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1090 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1091 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1092 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1093 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1094
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001095 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001097 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1098 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1099 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1100
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001101 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1102 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1103 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1104 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001105
1106 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001107 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1108 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1109 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1110 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1111 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1112 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001114 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001116log-send-hostname [<string>]
1117 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1118 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1119 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1120 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1121 the logs.
1122
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001123log-tag <string>
1124 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1125 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1126 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001127 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001128
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001129lua-load <file>
1130 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1131 used multiple times.
1132
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001133lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1134 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1135 variable.
1136 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1137 to "path".
1138
1139 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1140 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1141 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1142 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1143 will be checked earlier.
1144
1145 As an example by specifying the following path:
1146
1147 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1148 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1149
1150 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1151 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1152 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1153 paths if that does not exist either.
1154
1155 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1156 documentation.
1157
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001158master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001159 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1160 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1161 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001162 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001163 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1164 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001165 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1166 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1167 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1168 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1169 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001170
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001171 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001172
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001173mworker-max-reloads <number>
1174 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001175 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001176 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1177 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1178 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1179
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001180nbproc <number>
1181 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1182 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1183 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001184 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1185 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001186 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1187 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001189nbthread <number>
1190 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001191 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1192 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1193 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1194 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1195 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001196 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1197 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1198 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1199 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1200 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1201 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1202 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001203
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001204pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001205 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1206 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1207 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1208 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001209
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001210pp2-never-send-local
1211 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1212 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1213 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1214 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1215 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1216 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1217 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1218 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1219 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1220 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1221 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1222
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001223presetenv <name> <value>
1224 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1225 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1226 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1227 and "unsetenv".
1228
1229resetenv [<name> ...]
1230 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1231 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1232 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1233 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1234 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1235 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1236 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1237 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1238
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001239stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001240 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1241 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1242 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1243 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1244 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1245 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001246 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001247 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1248 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1249 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1250 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001251
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001252server-state-base <directory>
1253 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001254 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1255 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001256
1257server-state-file <file>
1258 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1259 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1260 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1261 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1262 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1263 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1264 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1265 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001266 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1267 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001268
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001269setenv <name> <value>
1270 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1271 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1272 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1273 and "unsetenv".
1274
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001275set-dumpable
1276 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001277 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1278 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1279 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1280 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1281 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1282 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1283 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1284 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1285 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1286 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1287 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1288 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1289 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1290 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1291 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1292 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1293 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001294
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001295ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1297 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001298 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001299 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001300 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1301 information and recommendations see e.g.
1302 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1303 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1304 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1305 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001306
1307ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1309 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1310 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1311 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1312 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001313 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1314 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1315 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001316 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001317
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001318ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1320 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1321 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1322 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1323 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1324
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001325ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1326 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1327 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1328 keyword to see available options.
1329
1330 Example:
1331 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001332 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001333
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001334ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1336 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001337 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001338 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001339 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1340 information and recommendations see e.g.
1341 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1342 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1343 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1344 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1345 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001346
1347ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1349 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1350 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1351 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1352 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001353 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1354 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1355 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1356 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001357
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001358ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1360 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1361 keyword to see available options.
1362
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001363ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1365 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1366 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001367 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001368 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001369 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1370 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1371 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1372 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001373 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1374 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1375 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1376
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001377ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001378 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001379 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1380 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001381
1382 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1383 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1384 optimize the startup time.
1385
1386 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1387 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1388 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1389
1390 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001391 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001392
1393 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001394 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1395
1396 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1397 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1398 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1399 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1400 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1401 bind configuration..
1402
1403 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1404 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1405 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1406 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1407 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1408 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1409 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1410 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1411
1412 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1413
1414 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1415 a cert bundle.
1416
1417 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1418 separately in several "crt".
1419
1420 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1421 since files are loading separately.
1422
1423 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1424 required to commit them.
1425
1426 OSCP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
1427 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001428
1429 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1430
1431 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1432
1433 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1434 not provided in the PEM file.
1435
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001436 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1437 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1438
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001439 The default behavior is "all".
1440
1441 Example:
1442 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1443 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1444 ssl-load-extra-files none
1445
1446 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1447
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001448ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1449 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1450 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1451 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1452
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001453ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001454 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001455 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1456 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1457 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1458 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1459 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1460 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001461 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001462
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001463stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1464 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1465 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1466 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001467 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001468 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001469
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001470 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1471 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1472 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001473
1474stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1475 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1476 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001477 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001478
1479stats maxconn <connections>
1480 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1481 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1482
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001483uid <number>
1484 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1485 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1486 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1487 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1488
1489ulimit-n <number>
1490 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1491 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1492 option.
1493
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001494unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1495 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1496
1497 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1498 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1499 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1500 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1501 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1502 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1503 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1504 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1505 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1506 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1507
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001508unsetenv [<name> ...]
1509 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1510 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1511 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1512 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1513 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1514 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1515 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001517user <user name>
1518 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1519 See also "uid" and "group".
1520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001521node <name>
1522 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1523
1524 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1525 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1526 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1527 traffic.
1528
1529description <text>
1530 Add a text that describes the instance.
1531
1532 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1533 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1534 "<" and ">" characters.
1535
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100153651degrees-data-file <file path>
1537 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001538 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001539
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001540 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001541 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1542
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000154351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001544 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1545 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1546 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1547
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001548 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001549 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1550
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200155151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001552 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1553 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1554
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001555 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1556 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1557
155851degrees-cache-size <number>
1559 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1560 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1561 By default, this cache is disabled.
1562
1563 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001564 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1565
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001566wurfl-data-file <file path>
1567 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1568 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1569
1570 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1571 with USE_WURFL=1.
1572
1573wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1574 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1575 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1576 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1577
1578 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1579
1580 Valid WURFL properties are:
1581 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1582
1583 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1584 device.
1585
1586 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1587 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1588
1589 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1590 particular web request.
1591
1592 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1593 used Libwurfl API version.
1594
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001595 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1596 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1597
1598 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1599 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1600
1601 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1602
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001603 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1604 with USE_WURFL=1.
1605
1606wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1607 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1608 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1609
1610 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1611 with USE_WURFL=1.
1612
1613wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1614 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1615 thus before the chroot.
1616
1617 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1618 with USE_WURFL=1.
1619
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001620wurfl-cache-size <size>
1621 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1622 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001623 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001624 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001625
1626 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1627 with USE_WURFL=1.
1628
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001629strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001630 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1631 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1632 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1633 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1634 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016363.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001637-----------------------
1638
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001639busy-polling
1640 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1641 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1642 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1643 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1644 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1645 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1646 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1647 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1648 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1649 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1650 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1651 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1652 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1653 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1654 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1655 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1656 "poll" pollers.
1657
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001658 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1659 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1660 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1661
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001662max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1663 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1664 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1665 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1666 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1667 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1668 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1669 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1670 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001672maxconn <number>
1673 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1674 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1675 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001676 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1677 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1678 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1679 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001680 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1681 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1682 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1683 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1684 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1685 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001686
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001687maxconnrate <number>
1688 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1689 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1690 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1691 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1692 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1693 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1694 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1695 fairness.
1696
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001697maxcomprate <number>
1698 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001699 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001700 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1701 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1702 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001703 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001704 default value.
1705
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001706maxcompcpuusage <number>
1707 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1708 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1709 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1710 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1711 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1712 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1713 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1714 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1715
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001716maxpipes <number>
1717 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1718 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1719 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1720 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1721 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1722 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1723
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001724maxsessrate <number>
1725 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1726 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1727 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1728 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1729 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1730 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1731 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1732 fairness.
1733
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001734maxsslconn <number>
1735 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1736 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1737 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1738 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1739 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1740 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1741 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001742 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1743 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1744 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1745 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1746 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1747 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1748 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001749
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001750maxsslrate <number>
1751 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1752 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1753 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1754 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1755 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1756 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1757 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1758 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1759 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1760 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1761
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001762maxzlibmem <number>
1763 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1764 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1765 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001766 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1767 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1768 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001770noepoll
1771 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1772 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001773 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001774
1775nokqueue
1776 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1777 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1778 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1779
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001780noevports
1781 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1782 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1783 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1784 also "nopoll".
1785
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001786nopoll
1787 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1788 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001790 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1791 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001792
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001793nosplice
1794 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001795 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001796 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001797 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001798 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1799 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1800 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1801 "option splice-response".
1802
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001803nogetaddrinfo
1804 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1805 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1806
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001807noreuseport
1808 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1809 command line argument "-dR".
1810
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001811profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1812 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1813 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1814 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1815 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001816 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001817 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1818 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1819 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1820 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1821
1822 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1823 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1824 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1825 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1826 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001827 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1828 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1829 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1830 CLI.
1831
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001832spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001833 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1834 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1835 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1836 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1837 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1838 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001839
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001840ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001841 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001842 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001843 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1844 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1845 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1846 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1847 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001848 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1849 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001850 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1851 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1852 openssl configuration file uses:
1853 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1854
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001855ssl-mode-async
1856 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001857 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001858 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1859 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1860 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001861 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001862 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001863
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001864tune.buffers.limit <number>
1865 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1866 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1867 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1868 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1869 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001870 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001871 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1872 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1873 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1874 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1875 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1876 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1877 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1878 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1879 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1880
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001881tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1882 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1883 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1884 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1885 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1886
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001887tune.bufsize <number>
1888 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1889 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1890 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1891 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1892 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1893 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1894 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001895 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1896 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1897 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001898 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001899 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1900 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1901 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001902
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001903tune.chksize <number>
1904 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1905 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1906 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1907 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1908 checks whenever possible.
1909
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001910tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1911 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1912 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1913 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1914 this value. The default value is 1.
1915
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001916tune.fail-alloc
1917 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1918 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1919 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1920 gracefully.
1921
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001922tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1923 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1924 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1925 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1926 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1927 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1928
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001929tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1930 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1931 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1932 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1933 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1934 change it.
1935
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001936tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1937 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001938 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1939 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001940 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1941 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1942 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1943 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1944 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1945
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001946tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1947 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1948 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1949 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1950 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1951 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1952 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1953 recommended not to change this value.
1954
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001955tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1956 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1957 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1958 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1959 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1960 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1961 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1962 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1963
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001964tune.http.cookielen <number>
1965 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1966 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1967 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1968 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1969 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1970 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1971 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1972 to change this value.
1973
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001974tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001975 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1976 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001977 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001978 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001979 configuration directives too.
1980 The default value is 1024.
1981
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001982tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1983 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1984 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1985 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1986 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1987 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1988 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001989 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1990 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1991 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001992
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001993tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1994 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1995 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1996 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1997 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1998 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1999 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2000 this option to "off". The default is on.
2001
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002002tune.idletimer <timeout>
2003 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2004 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2005 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2006 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2007 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2008 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002009 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002010 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002011 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2012
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002013tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2014 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2015 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2016 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2017 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2018 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2019 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2020 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2021 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2022 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2023
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002024tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2025 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002026 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002027 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2028 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002029 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002030 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2031 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2032
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002033tune.lua.maxmem
2034 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2035 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2036 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2037 memory.
2038
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002039tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2040 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002041 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2042 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002043 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002044
2045tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2046 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2047 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2048 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2049 check servers.
2050
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002051tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2052 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2053 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2054 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002055 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002056
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002057tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002058 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2059 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2060 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2061 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2062 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2063 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2064 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2065 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2066 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2067 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002068
2069tune.maxpollevents <number>
2070 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2071 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2072 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2073 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2074 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2075
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002076tune.maxrewrite <number>
2077 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2078 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2079 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2080 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2081 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2082 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2083 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2084 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2085 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2086 bufsize.
2087
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002088tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2089 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2090 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2091 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2092 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2093 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2094 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2095 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2096 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2097 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002098 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2099 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002100 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2101 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2102 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2103 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2104 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2105 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2106 setting this parameter to 0.
2107
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002108tune.pipesize <number>
2109 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2110 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2111 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2112 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2113 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2114 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2115
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002116tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2117 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2118 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2119 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2120 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2121 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2122 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002123 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002124
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002125tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2126 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2127 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2128 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2129 default is 20.
2130
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002131tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2132tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2133 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2134 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2135 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002136 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002137 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002138 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2139 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2140
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002141tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002142 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002143 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2144 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2145 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2146 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2147
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002148tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002149 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002150 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002151 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2152 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2153 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2154
2155tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2156 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2157 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2158 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2159 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2160 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2161 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2162 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2163 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2164 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002165
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002166tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2167tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2168 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2169 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2170 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002171 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002172 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002173 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2174 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2175 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2176 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2177 notifying haproxy again.
2178
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002179tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002180 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2181 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2182 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002183 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002184 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002185 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002186 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2187 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2188 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002189 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2190 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002191
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002192tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002193 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002194 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2195 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2196 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2197 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2198 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2199
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002200tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2201 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2202 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2203 performances. This is disabled by default.
2204
2205 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2206 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2207
2208 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2209
2210 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2211
2212 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2213
2214 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2215 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2216 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2217
2218 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2219 converted.
2220
2221 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2222 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2223 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2224 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2225 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2226 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2227 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002228 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2229 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002230
2231 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2232
2233 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2234 only need this line:
2235
2236 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2237
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002238tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2239 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002240 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002241 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2242 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2243 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2244 being used for too long.
2245
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002246tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2247 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2248 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2249 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2250 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2251 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2252 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2253 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2254 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2255 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2256 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002257 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002258 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002259
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002260tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2261 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2262 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2263 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2264 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002265 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002266 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2267 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002268 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2269 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002270
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002271tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2272 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2273 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2274 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2275 1000 entries.
2276
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002277tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2278 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2279 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2280 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2281
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002282tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002283tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002284tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2285tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2286tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002287 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2288 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2289 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2290 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2291 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2292 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2293 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2294 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002295
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002296 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2297 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2298 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2299 all available space is consumed.
2300 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2301 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2302 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002303
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002304tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2305 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002306 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002307 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002308 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002309 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2310
2311tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2312 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2313 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002314 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2315 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023173.3. Debugging
2318--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002319
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002320debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002321 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2322 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2323 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2324 system startup.
2325
2326quiet
2327 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2328 line argument "-q".
2329
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002330zero-warning
2331 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2332 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2333 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2334 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2335 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2336 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2337
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023393.4. Userlists
2340--------------
2341It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2342http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2343it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2344
2345userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002346 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002347 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2348
2349group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002350 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002351 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2352 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2353
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002354user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2355 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002356 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2357 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002358 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2359 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2360 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2361 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002362
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002363 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2364 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2365 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2366 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2367 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2368 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2369 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2370 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2371 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002372
2373 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002374 userlist L1
2375 group G1 users tiger,scott
2376 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002377
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002378 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2379 user scott insecure-password elgato
2380 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002381
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002382 userlist L2
2383 group G1
2384 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002385
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002386 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2387 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2388 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002389
2390 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002391
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002392
23933.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002394----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002395It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2396several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2397instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2398values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2399automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2400In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2401using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2402tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2403reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2404Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2405that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2406each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002407
2408peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002409 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002410 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2411
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002412bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2413 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2414 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2415
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002416disabled
2417 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2418 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2419 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2420
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002421default-bind [param*]
2422 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2423
2424default-server [param*]
2425 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2426
2427 Arguments:
2428 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2429 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2430 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2431 details.
2432
2433
2434 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2435
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002436enable
2437 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2438
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002439log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2440 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2441 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2442 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2443 more details.
2444
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002445peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002446 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2447 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002448 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2449 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2450 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2451 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2452 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002453
2454 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2455 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2456
2457 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002458 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2459 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2460 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002462 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2463 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002464
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002465 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2466 "server" keyword explanation below).
2467
2468server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002469 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002470 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2471 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2472 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2473 of this "peers" section).
2474 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2475
2476
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002477 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002478 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002479 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002480 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2481 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2482 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002483
2484 backend mybackend
2485 mode tcp
2486 balance roundrobin
2487 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2488 stick on src
2489
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002490 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2491 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002492
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002493 Example:
2494 peers mypeers
2495 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2496 default-server ssl verify none
2497 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2498 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002499
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002500
2501table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2502 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2503
2504 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2505 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002506 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002507 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2508 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2509 "stick-table" keyword).
2510
2511 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2512 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2513 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2514 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2515 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2516 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2517 of the stick-table name as follows:
2518
2519 peers mypeers
2520 peer A ...
2521 peer B ...
2522 table t1 ...
2523
2524 frontend fe1
2525 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2526
2527 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2528 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2529
2530 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2531 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2532 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2533 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2534 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2535 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2536 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2537
2538 peers mypeers
2539 peer A ...
2540 peer B ...
2541 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2542
2543 backend t1
2544 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2545
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002546 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002547 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2548 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2549
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025503.6. Mailers
2551------------
2552It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2553If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2554in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2555
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002556mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002557 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2558 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2559
2560mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2561 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2562
2563 Example:
2564 mailers mymailers
2565 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2566 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2567
2568 backend mybackend
2569 mode tcp
2570 balance roundrobin
2571
2572 email-alert mailers mymailers
2573 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2574 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2575
2576 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2577 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2578
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002579timeout mail <time>
2580 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2581 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2582 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2583 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2584
2585 Example:
2586 mailers mymailers
2587 timeout mail 20s
2588 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002589
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025903.7. Programs
2591-------------
2592In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2593master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2594managed the same way as the workers.
2595
2596During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2597sequence as a worker:
2598
2599 - the master is re-executed
2600 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2601 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2602 instance of the program
2603
2604During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2605
2606program <name>
2607 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2608 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2609 the management guide).
2610
2611command <command> [arguments*]
2612 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2613 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2614 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2615 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2616
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002617user <user name>
2618 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2619 See also "group".
2620
2621group <group name>
2622 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2623 See also "user".
2624
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002625option start-on-reload
2626no option start-on-reload
2627 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2628 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2629 program section.
2630
2631
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026323.8. HTTP-errors
2633----------------
2634
2635It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2636imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2637several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2638
2639http-errors <name>
2640 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2641 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2642
2643errorfile <code> <file>
2644 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2645
2646 Arguments :
2647 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002648 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2649 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002650
2651 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2652 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2653 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2654 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2655 before any chroot is performed.
2656
2657 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2658
2659 Example:
2660 http-errors website-1
2661 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2662 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2663 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2664
2665 http-errors website-2
2666 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2667 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2668 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2669
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026703.9. Rings
2671----------
2672
2673It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2674servers or traces.
2675
2676ring <ringname>
2677 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2678
2679description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002680 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002681 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2682
2683format <format>
2684 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2685
2686 Arguments:
2687 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2688 one of the following :
2689
2690 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2691 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2692 designed to be used with a local log server.
2693
2694 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2695 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2696 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2697 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2698 is the default.
2699
2700 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2701 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2702
2703 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2704 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2705
2706 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2707 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2708 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2709 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2710 logger consumes.
2711
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002712 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2713 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2714 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2715 with a local log server.
2716
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002717 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2718 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2719 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2720 used with a local log server.
2721
2722maxlen <length>
2723 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2724 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2725 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2726
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002727server <name> <address> [param*]
2728 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2729 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2730 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2731 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2732 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2733 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2734 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2735 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2736 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002737 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2738 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002739
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002740size <size>
2741 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2742 set to BUFSIZE.
2743
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002744timeout connect <timeout>
2745 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2746
2747 Arguments :
2748 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2750 as explained at the top of this document.
2751
2752timeout server <timeout>
2753 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2754
2755 Arguments :
2756 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2757 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2758 as explained at the top of this document.
2759
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002760 Example:
2761 global
2762 log ring@myring local7
2763
2764 ring myring
2765 description "My local buffer"
2766 format rfc3164
2767 maxlen 1200
2768 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002769 timeout connect 5s
2770 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002771 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002772
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027733.10. Log forwarding
2774-------------------
2775
2776It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2777haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2778
2779log-forward <name>
2780 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2781
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02002782dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
2783 Used to configure a UDP log listener to receive messages to forward. Only UDP
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02002784 listeners are allowed. Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a
2785 port. This supports for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph
2786 among which "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
2787 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002788
2789log global
2790log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2791 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2792 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2793 documentation.
2794 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2795 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2796 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2797 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2798 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2799
2800 Example:
2801 global
2802 log stderr format iso local7
2803
2804 ring myring
2805 description "My local buffer"
2806 format rfc5424
2807 maxlen 1200
2808 size 32764
2809 timeout connect 5s
2810 timeout server 10s
2811 # syslog tcp server
2812 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2813
2814 log-forward sylog-loadb
2815 bind udp4@127.0.0.1:1514
2816 # all messages on stderr
2817 log global
2818 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2819 log ring@myring local0
2820 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2821 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2822 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2823 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2824 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028264. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002827----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002829Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002830 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002831 - frontend <name>
2832 - backend <name>
2833 - listen <name>
2834
2835A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2836its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2837section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002838section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002839
2840A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2841connections.
2842
2843A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2844to forward incoming connections.
2845
2846A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2847parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2848
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002849All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2850'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2851case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2852
2853Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2854logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2855proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2856However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2857name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2858
2859Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2860and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002861bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2863modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2864arbitrary criteria.
2865
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002866In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2867a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002868the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002869
2870 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2871 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2872 between responses and new requests.
2873
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002874 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2875 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2876 client-facing connection remains open.
2877
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002878 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2879 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002880
2881The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2882frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2883following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002884weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002885
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002886 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002887
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002888 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2889 ----+-----+-----+----
2890 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2891 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002892 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2893 ----+-----+-----+----
2894 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002896
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028984.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2899--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002901The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2902limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2903they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2904limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002905marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002906option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002907and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2908with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2909specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002910
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002911
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002912 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2913------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2914acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002915backlog X X X -
2916balance X - X X
2917bind - X X -
2918bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002919capture cookie - X X -
2920capture request header - X X -
2921capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002922clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2923clitcpka-idle X X X -
2924clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002925compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002926cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002927declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002928default-server X - X X
2929default_backend X X X -
2930description - X X X
2931disabled X X X X
2932dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002933email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002934email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002935email-alert mailers X X X X
2936email-alert myhostname X X X X
2937email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002938enabled X X X X
2939errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002940errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002941errorloc X X X X
2942errorloc302 X X X X
2943-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2944errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002945force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002946filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002947fullconn X - X X
2948grace X X X X
2949hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002950http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002951http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002952http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002953http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002954http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002955http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002956http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002957http-check set-var X - X X
2958http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002959http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002960http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002961http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002962http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002963http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002964id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002965ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002966load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002967log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002968log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002969log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002970log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002971max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002972maxconn X X X -
2973mode X X X X
2974monitor fail - X X -
2975monitor-net X X X -
2976monitor-uri X X X -
2977option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2978option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2979option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2980option allbackups (*) X - X X
2981option checkcache (*) X - X X
2982option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2983option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002984option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002985option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2986option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002987-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2988option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002989option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2990option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002991option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002992option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002993option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002994option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002995option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002996option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2997option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2998option httpchk X - X X
2999option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003000option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003001option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003002option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003003option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003004option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003005option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3006option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3007option logasap (*) X X X -
3008option mysql-check X - X X
3009option nolinger (*) X X X X
3010option originalto X X X X
3011option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003012option pgsql-check X - X X
3013option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003014option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003015option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003016option smtpchk X - X X
3017option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3018option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3019option splice-request (*) X X X X
3020option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003021option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003022option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3023option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3024-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003025option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003026option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3027option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3028option tcpka X X X X
3029option tcplog X X X X
3030option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003031external-check command X - X X
3032external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003033persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3034rate-limit sessions X X X -
3035redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003036-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003037retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003038retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003039server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003040server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003041server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003042source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003043srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3044srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3045srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003046stats admin - X X X
3047stats auth X X X X
3048stats enable X X X X
3049stats hide-version X X X X
3050stats http-request - X X X
3051stats realm X X X X
3052stats refresh X X X X
3053stats scope X X X X
3054stats show-desc X X X X
3055stats show-legends X X X X
3056stats show-node X X X X
3057stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003058-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3059stick match - - X X
3060stick on - - X X
3061stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003062stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003063stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003064tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003065tcp-check connect X - X X
3066tcp-check expect X - X X
3067tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003068tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003069tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003070tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003071tcp-check set-var X - X X
3072tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003073tcp-request connection - X X -
3074tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003075tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003076tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003077tcp-response content - - X X
3078tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003079timeout check X - X X
3080timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003081timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003082timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003083timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3084timeout http-request X X X X
3085timeout queue X - X X
3086timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003087timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003088timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003089timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003090transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003091unique-id-format X X X -
3092unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003093use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003094use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003095use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003096------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3097 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003098
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031004.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3101---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003102
3103This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3104
3105
3106acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3107 Declare or complete an access list.
3108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3109 no | yes | yes | yes
3110 Example:
3111 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3112 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3113 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003115 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
3117
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003118backlog <conns>
3119 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3121 yes | yes | yes | no
3122 Arguments :
3123 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3124 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003125 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003126
3127 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3128 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3129 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3130 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3131 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3132 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3133 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3134 backlog parameter.
3135
3136 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3137 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3138 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3139
3140 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3141
3142
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003144balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3147 yes | no | yes | yes
3148 Arguments :
3149 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3150 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3151 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3152 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3153
3154 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3155 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3156 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3157 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003158 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003159 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003160 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3161 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3162 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3163 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3164 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3165 it, so that you don't worry.
3166
3167 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3168 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3169 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3170 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3171 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3172 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3173 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3174 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003176 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3177 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3178 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3179 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3180 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3181 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3182 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3183 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3184
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003185 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003186 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003187 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3188 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003189 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003190 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3191 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3192 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3193 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3194 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003195 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3196 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3197 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3198 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3199 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3200 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003201
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3203 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3204 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3205 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3206 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3207 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3208 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3209 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003210 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003211 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003212 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3213 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3214 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003215
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003216 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3217 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3218 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3219 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3220 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3221 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3222 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3223 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3224 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3225 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3226 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3227 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003228
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003229 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003230 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3231 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3232 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3233 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3234 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3235 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3236 URIs start with a leading "/".
3237
3238 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3239 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3240 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3241 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3242
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003243 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3244 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3245 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3246 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3247
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003248 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003249 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3250
3251 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003252 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3253 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003254 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3255 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3256 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3257 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003258 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003259 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3260 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003261
3262 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3263 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3264 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3265 server will receive the request.
3266
3267 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3268 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3269 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3270 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3271 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003272 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3273 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3274 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003276 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3277 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3278 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3279 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3280 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003282 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003283 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3284 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3285 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3286
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003287 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3288 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3289 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3290
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003291 random
3292 random(<draws>)
3293 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003294 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3295 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3296 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3297 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003298 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3299 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3300 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3301 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3302 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3303 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3304 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3305 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3306 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3307 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3308 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3309 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3310 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3311 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3312 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3313 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3314 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3315 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3316 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3317 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003318
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003319 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003320 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003321 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3322 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3323 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3324 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3325 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3326 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003327 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003328 used instead.
3329
3330 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3331 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3332 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3333 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3334
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003335 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3336 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3337 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3338
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003339 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003341 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003342 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3343 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003344
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003345 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3346 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3347 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003348
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003349 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003350 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003351 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3352 NTLM relies on.
3353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354 Examples :
3355 balance roundrobin
3356 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003357 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003358 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3359 balance hdr(host)
3360 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003361
3362 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3363 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003365 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003366 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3367 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3368 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003369 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003370
3371 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3372 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3373 defaults to 16 kB.
3374
3375 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3376 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3377
3378 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3379 Round Robin.
3380
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003381 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003382 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3383 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3384 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3385
3386 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3387
3388 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003389 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003390 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3391 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3392 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003393
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003394 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395
3396
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003397bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3398bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003399 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 no | yes | yes | no
3402 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003403 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3404 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3405 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3406 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003407 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003408 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3409 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3410 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3411 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3412 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3413 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003414 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003415 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3416 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003417 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003418 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3419 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003420 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003421 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3422 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003423 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003424 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3425 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3426 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3427 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3428 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3429 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3430 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003431 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3432 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3433 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003434 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3435 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3436 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3437 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003438 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3439 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3440 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003441
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003442 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3443 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003444 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3445 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3446 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003447 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3448 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3449 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3450 the range.
3451
3452 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3453 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3454 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3455 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3456 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3457 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3458 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003459 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003460 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003462 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003463 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003464 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3465 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3466 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3467 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3468 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3469 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3470
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003471 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3472 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3473 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3474 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3477 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3478 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3479 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3480 in a frontend.
3481
3482 Example :
3483 listen http_proxy
3484 bind :80,:443
3485 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003486 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003487
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003488 listen http_https_proxy
3489 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003490 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003491
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003492 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3493 bind ipv6@:80
3494 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3495 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3496
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003497 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003498 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003499
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003500 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3501 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3502 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3503 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3504 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3505
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003506 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003507 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003508
3509
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003510bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003511 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3513 yes | yes | yes | yes
3514 Arguments :
3515 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3516 may be used to override a default value.
3517
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003518 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003519 option may be combined with other numbers.
3520
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003521 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003522 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3523 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3524 missing from all processes.
3525
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003526 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003527 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003528 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3529 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3530 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3531 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3532 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003533 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003534
3535 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3536 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3537 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3538 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3539 and 'even' instances.
3540
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003541 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3542 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3543 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3544 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003545
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003546 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3547 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3548
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003549 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3550 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3551 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3552
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003553 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3554 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3555
3556 Example :
3557 listen app_ip1
3558 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003559 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003560
3561 listen app_ip2
3562 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003563 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003564
3565 listen management
3566 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003567 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003568
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003569 listen management
3570 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3571 bind-process 1-4
3572
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003573 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003574
3575
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003576capture cookie <name> len <length>
3577 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3579 no | yes | yes | no
3580 Arguments :
3581 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3582 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3583 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3584 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003585 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
3587 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3588 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3589 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3590 right if it exceeds <length>.
3591
3592 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3593 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3594 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3595 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3596
3597 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3598 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3599 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3600
3601 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3602 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3603 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003604 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3605 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3606 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003607
3608 Example:
3609 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3610
3611 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003612 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003613
3614
3615capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003616 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 no | yes | yes | no
3619 Arguments :
3620 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003621 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003622 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3623 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3624 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3625
3626 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3627 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3628 it exceeds <length>.
3629
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003630 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003631 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3632 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003633 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3634 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3635 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3636 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003637 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003638 environments to find where the request came from.
3639
3640 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3641 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3642 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3643 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003644
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003645 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3646 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3647 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3648 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3649 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003650
3651 Example:
3652 capture request header Host len 15
3653 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003654 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003656 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003657 about logging.
3658
3659
3660capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003661 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3663 no | yes | yes | no
3664 Arguments :
3665 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003666 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003667 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3668 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3669 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3670
3671 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3672 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3673 it exceeds <length>.
3674
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003675 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003676 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3677 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3678 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003679 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3680 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3681 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3682 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003683
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003684 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3685 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3686 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3687 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3688 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003689
3690 Example:
3691 capture response header Content-length len 9
3692 capture response header Location len 15
3693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003694 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695 about logging.
3696
3697
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003698clitcpka-cnt <count>
3699 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3700 the connection on the client side.
3701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3702 yes | yes | yes | no
3703 Arguments :
3704 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3705
3706 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3707 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003708 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3709 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003710
3711 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3712
3713
3714clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3715 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3716 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3717 client side.
3718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3719 yes | yes | yes | no
3720 Arguments :
3721 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3722 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3723 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3724 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3725
3726 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3727 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003728 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3729 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003730
3731 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3732
3733
3734clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3735 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3737 yes | yes | yes | no
3738 Arguments :
3739 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3740 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3741 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3742 document.
3743
3744 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3745 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003746 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3747 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003748
3749 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3750
3751
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003752compression algo <algorithm> ...
3753compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003754compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003755 Enable HTTP compression.
3756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3757 yes | yes | yes | yes
3758 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003759 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3760 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3761 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3762
3763 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003764 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3765 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3766 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003767
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003768 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003769 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003770
3771 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3772 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3773 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3774 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3775 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003776 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003777
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003778 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3779 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3780 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3781 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3782 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3783 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3784 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003785 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003786
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003787 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003788 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003789 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3790 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3791 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3792 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3793 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003794
3795 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3796 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3797 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3798 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3799 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003800 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3801 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3802 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3803 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3804 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003805 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3806 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003807
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003808 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003809 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3810 "Accept-Encoding" header
3811 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003812 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003813 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3814 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3815 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3816 "multipart"
3817 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3818 header
3819 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3820 and later
3821 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3822 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003823 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003824
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003825 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003826
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003827 Examples :
3828 compression algo gzip
3829 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003830
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003831
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003832cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003833 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3834 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003835 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003836 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3838 yes | no | yes | yes
3839 Arguments :
3840 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3841 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3842 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3843 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3844 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3845 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003846 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003847 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3848 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3849
3850 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3851 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3852 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3853 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3854 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3855 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003856 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3857 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003858 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003859 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3860 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003861
3862 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003863 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003864
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003865 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003866 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003867 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003868 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003869 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3870 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3871 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3872 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3873 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3874 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3875 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003876
3877 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3878 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3879 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3880 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3881 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3882 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3883 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3884 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3885 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003886 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003887 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3888 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3889 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003890
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003891 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3892 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3893 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003894 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3895 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3896 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3897 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003898 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3899 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3900 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003901
3902 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3903 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3904 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3905 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3906 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3907 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3908 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3909 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3910 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3911
3912 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3913 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3914 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3915 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3916 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3917 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3918 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3919 persistence cookie in the cache.
3920 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3921
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003922 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3923 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3924 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3925 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3926 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003927 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003928 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3929 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3930 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3931 they logout.
3932
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003933 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3934 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3935 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3936 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3937
3938 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3939 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3940 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3941 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3942 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3943 this attribute.
3944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003945 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003946 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003947 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3948 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3949 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3950 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3951 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3952 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003953
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003954 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3955 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3956 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3957 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3958 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3959 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3960 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3961 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003962 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003963 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3964 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3965 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3966 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3967 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3968 the site.
3969
3970 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3971 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3972 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3973 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3974 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3975 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3976 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3977 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3978 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3979 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3980 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3981 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3982 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003983 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003984 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3985 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3986
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003987 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3988 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3989 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3990 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3991 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3992 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3993
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003994 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3995 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3996 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3997 repeated.
3998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003999 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4000 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4001 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4002 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004 Examples :
4005 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4006 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4007 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004008 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004009
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004010 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004011
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004012
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004013declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4014 Declares a capture slot.
4015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4016 no | yes | yes | no
4017 Arguments:
4018 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4019
4020 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4021 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4022 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4023 for use in the response.
4024
4025 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004026 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004027 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4028
4029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004030default-server [param*]
4031 Change default options for a server in a backend
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 yes | no | yes | yes
4034 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004035 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4036 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4037 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4038 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004039
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004040 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004041 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4042
4043 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004044
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004046default_backend <backend>
4047 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4049 yes | yes | yes | no
4050 Arguments :
4051 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4052
4053 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4054 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4055 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4056 will catch all undetermined requests.
4057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058 Example :
4059
4060 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4061 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4062 default_backend dynamic
4063
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004064 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004065
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004066
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004067description <string>
4068 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4070 no | yes | yes | yes
4071 Arguments : string
4072
4073 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4074 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4075 it describes.
4076 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4077
4078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004079disabled
4080 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4082 yes | yes | yes | yes
4083 Arguments : none
4084
4085 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4086 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4087 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4088 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4089 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4090 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4091 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4092
4093 See also : "enabled"
4094
4095
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004096dispatch <address>:<port>
4097 Set a default server address
4098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4099 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004100 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004101
4102 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4103 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4104 during start-up.
4105
4106 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4107 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4108 possible with normal servers.
4109
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004110 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004111 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4112 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4113 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4114 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4115
4116 See also : "server"
4117
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004118
4119dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4120 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4122 yes | no | yes | yes
4123 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4124
4125 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004126 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004127 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4128 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004129 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004130 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004131
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004132enabled
4133 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4135 yes | yes | yes | yes
4136 Arguments : none
4137
4138 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4139 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4140
4141 See also : "disabled"
4142
4143
4144errorfile <code> <file>
4145 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4147 yes | yes | yes | yes
4148 Arguments :
4149 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004150 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004151 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152
4153 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004154 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004155 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004156 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4157 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004158
4159 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4160 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4161 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4162
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004163 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4164
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004165 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4166 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4167 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4168 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4169 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4170 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4171 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4172 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4173 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004174
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004175 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4176 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4177 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004178 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004179 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4180
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004181 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004182
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004183 Example :
4184 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004185 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004186 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4187 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4188
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004189
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004190errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4191 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4192 section.
4193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4194 yes | yes | yes | yes
4195 Arguments :
4196 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4197
4198 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004199 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004200 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004201
4202 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4203 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4204 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4205 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4206 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004207 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004208 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4209
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004210 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4211 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004212
4213 Example :
4214 errorfiles generic
4215 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4216
4217
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004218errorloc <code> <url>
4219errorloc302 <code> <url>
4220 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4222 yes | yes | yes | yes
4223 Arguments :
4224 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004225 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004226 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004227
4228 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4229 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4230 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4231 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004232 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004233
4234 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4235 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4236 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4237
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004238 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4239
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004240 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4241 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4242 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4243 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004244 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004245 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4246 request.
4247
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004248 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004249
4250
4251errorloc303 <code> <url>
4252 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4254 yes | yes | yes | yes
4255 Arguments :
4256 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004257 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004258 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004259
4260 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4261 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4262 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4263 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004264 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004265
4266 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4267 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4268 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4269
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004270 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4271
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004272 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4273 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4274 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4275 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004276 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004277
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004278 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004279
4280
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004281email-alert from <emailaddr>
4282 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004283 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004284 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4285 yes | yes | yes | yes
4286
4287 Arguments :
4288
4289 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4290
4291 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4292 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4293
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004294 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004295 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4296 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004297
4298
4299email-alert level <level>
4300 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4301 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4302 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4303 yes | yes | yes | yes
4304
4305 Arguments :
4306
4307 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4308 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4309 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4310
4311 By default level is alert
4312
4313 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4314 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4315 for the proxy.
4316
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004317 Alerts are sent when :
4318
4319 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4320 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4321 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4322 is notice or lower
4323 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4324 and a health check status update occurs
4325
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004326 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4327 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004328 section 3.6 about mailers.
4329
4330
4331email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4332 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4334 yes | yes | yes | yes
4335
4336 Arguments :
4337
4338 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4339
4340 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4341 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4342
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004343 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4344 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004345
4346
4347email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4348 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4349 mailers.
4350 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4351 yes | yes | yes | yes
4352
4353 Arguments :
4354
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004355 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004356
4357 By default the systems hostname is used.
4358
4359 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4360 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4361 for the proxy.
4362
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004363 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4364 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004365
4366
4367email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004368 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004369 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4370 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4371 yes | yes | yes | yes
4372
4373 Arguments :
4374
4375 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4376
4377 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4378 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4379
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004380 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004381 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4382
4383
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004384force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4385 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4386 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004387 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004388
4389 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4390 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4391 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4392 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4393 marked down for maintenance operations.
4394
4395 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4396 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4397 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4398 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4399 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4400 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4401 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4402 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4403 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4404
4405 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4406 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4407 is used.
4408
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004409 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004410 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004411
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004412
4413filter <name> [param*]
4414 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4416 no | yes | yes | yes
4417 Arguments :
4418 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4419 referenced in section 9.
4420
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004421 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004422 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004423 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4424 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004425
4426 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4427 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4428
4429 Example:
4430 listen
4431 bind *:80
4432
4433 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4434 filter compression
4435 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4436
4437 compression algo gzip
4438 compression offload
4439
4440 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4441
4442 See also : section 9.
4443
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004444
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004445fullconn <conns>
4446 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4448 yes | no | yes | yes
4449 Arguments :
4450 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4451 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4452
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004453 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004454 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004455 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004456 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4457 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4458 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4459 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4460 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004461 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004462
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004463 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4464 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004465 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4466 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4467 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004468
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004469 Example :
4470 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4471 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4472 # connections.
4473 backend dynamic
4474 fullconn 10000
4475 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4476 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4477
4478 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4479
4480
4481grace <time>
4482 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004484 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004485 Arguments :
4486 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4487 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4488 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4489
4490 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4491 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004492 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004493 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4494
4495 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4496 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4497 simplify it.
4498
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004499
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004500hash-balance-factor <factor>
4501 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 yes | no | no | yes
4504 Arguments :
4505 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4506 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004507 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004508
4509 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4510 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4511 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4512 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4513 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4514 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4515 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4516
4517 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4518 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4519 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4520 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4521 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4522
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004523 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4524 consistent hashing mechanism.
4525
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004526 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4527
4528
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004529hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004530 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4532 yes | no | yes | yes
4533 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004534 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4535 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004536
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004537 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4538 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4539 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4540 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4541 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4542 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4543 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4544 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4545 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4546 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004547
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004548 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4549 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4550 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4551 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4552 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4553 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4554 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4555 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4556 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4557 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4558 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4559 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4560 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004561 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4562 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004563
4564 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4565
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004566 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004567 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4568 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4569 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004570 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4571 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4572 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004573
4574 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4575 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004576 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4577 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4578 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4579 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4580
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004581 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4582 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4583 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4584 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4585 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4586 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4587 parameter.
4588
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004589 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4590 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4591 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4592 used on strings.
4593
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004594 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4595
4596 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4597 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4598 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4599 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4600 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4601 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4602 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4603 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4604 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4605 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4606 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4607 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004608
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004609 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4610 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4611 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004612
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004613 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004614
4615
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004616http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4617 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4618 ones).
4619
4620 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4621 no | yes | yes | yes
4622
4623 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4624 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4625 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4626 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4627 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4628 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4629
4630 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4631 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4632 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4633
4634 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4635 below.
4636
4637 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4638 instance.
4639
4640 Example:
4641 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4642 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4643 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4644
4645http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4646
4647 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4648 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4649 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4650 example, or to pass some internal information.
4651 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4652 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4653 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4654
4655http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4656
4657 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4658 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4659
4660http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4661
4662 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4663
4664http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4665 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4666
4667 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4668
4669 Example:
4670 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4671
4672 # applied to:
4673 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4674
4675 # outputs:
4676 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4677
4678 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4679
4680http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4681 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4682
4683 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4684
4685 Example:
4686 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4687
4688 # applied to:
4689 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4690
4691 # outputs:
4692 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4693
4694http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4695
4696 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4697 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4698 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4699
4700http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4701 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4702
4703 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4704 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4705 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4706 fallback.
4707
4708 Example:
4709 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4710 http-response set-status 431
4711 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4712 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4713
4714http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4715
4716 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4717 inline.
4718
4719 Arguments:
4720 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4721 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4722 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4723 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4724 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4725 (request and response)
4726 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4727 processing
4728 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4729 processing
4730 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4731 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4732 and '_'.
4733
4734 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4735 followed by some converters.
4736
4737 Example:
4738 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4739
4740http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4741
4742 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4743 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4744 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4745 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4746 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004747 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004748 processing.
4749
4750 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4751 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004752 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004753 rules evaluation.
4754
4755http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4756
4757 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4758 details about <var-name>.
4759
4760 Example:
4761 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4762
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004763
4764http-check comment <string>
4765 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4766 it fails.
4767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4768 yes | no | yes | yes
4769
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004770 Arguments :
4771 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4772 rule fails.
4773
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004774 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4775 user-friendly error reporting.
4776
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004777 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004778 "http-check expect".
4779
4780
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004781http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4782 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004783 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004784 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4786 yes | no | yes | yes
4787
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004788 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004789 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4790
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004791 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004792 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004793
4794 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4795 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4796 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4797 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4798
4799 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4800
4801 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4802
4803 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4804
4805 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4806
4807 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4808
4809 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4810 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4811 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4812 is used.
4813
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004814 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4815 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4816 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4817 haproxy -vv.
4818
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004819 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4820
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004821 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4822 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4823 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4824 different ports or with different servers.
4825
4826 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4827 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4828 the port with a "http-check connect".
4829
4830 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4831 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4832 do.
4833
4834 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4835 unset-var or comment rules.
4836
4837 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004838 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4839 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4840 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4841 option httpchk
4842
4843 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004844 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004845 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004846 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004847 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004848 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004849
4850 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4851
4852 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004853
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004854
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004855http-check disable-on-404
4856 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004858 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004859 Arguments : none
4860
4861 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4862 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4863 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4864 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4865 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4866 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4867 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4868 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004869 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4870 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4871 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4872
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004873 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004874
4875
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004876http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004877 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4878 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4879 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004880 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004882 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004883
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004884 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004885 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4886
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004887 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4888 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4889 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4890 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4891 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4892 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4893 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4894 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4895 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4896 result is always conclusive.
4897
4898 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4899 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4900 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004901 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4902 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4903 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4904 example 404 with disable-on-404
4905 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4906 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4907 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004908
4909 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4910 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004911 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4912 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4913 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4914 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4915 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4916 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004917
4918 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4919 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004920 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4921 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4922 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4923 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004924 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4925
4926 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4927 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4928 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4929 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4930
4931 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4932 informational message reported in logs if an error
4933 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4934 log-format string.
4935
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004936 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004937 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4938 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004939 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4940 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4941 details on the supported keywords.
4942
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004943 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4944 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4945 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4946 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004947
4948 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4949 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4950 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4951 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4952 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4953
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004954 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4955 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4956 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4957 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4958 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4959 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4960 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004961
4962 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004963 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004964 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4965 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4966 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4967 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4968
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004969 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4970 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004971 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4972 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4973 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4974 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4975 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4976 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4977 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4978 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004979 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4980 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4981 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4982 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4983 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4984 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4985 insensitive on the header names.
4986
4987 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4988 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4989 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4990 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4991 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4992 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004993
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004994 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004995 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004996 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4997 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4998 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4999 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5000 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005001 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005002 trace).
5003
5004 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005005 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005006 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5007 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5008 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5009 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5010 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005011 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005012
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005013 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5014 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5015 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5016 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5017 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5018 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5019
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005020 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
5021 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
5022 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5023 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5024 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5025 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5026 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5027 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5028
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005029 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5030 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5031 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5032 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5033 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005034
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005035 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5036 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5037
5038 Examples :
5039 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005040 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005041
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005042 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5043 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5044
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005045 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005046 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005047
5048 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005049 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005050
5051 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005052 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005053
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005054 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005055 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005056
5057
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005058http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005059 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5060 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005061 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5062 health checks.
5063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 yes | no | yes | yes
5065 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005066 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5067
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005068 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5069 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5070 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5071 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5072 to invent non-standard ones.
5073
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005074 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5075 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5076 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5077 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5078
5079 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5080 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5081 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5082 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005083
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005084 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005085 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005086 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005087 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5088 to add it.
5089
5090 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5091 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5092 to the log-format rules.
5093
5094 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5095 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5096 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005097
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005098 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5099 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5100 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5101 request.
5102
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005103 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5104 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5105 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005106 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5107 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5108 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5109 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005110 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005111 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005112 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5113
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005114 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5115 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005116 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5117 so, it will be ignored.
5118
5119 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5120 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5121 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5122 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5123 configured request authority.
5124
5125 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5126 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005127
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005128 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005129
5130
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005131http-check send-state
5132 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5134 yes | no | yes | yes
5135 Arguments : none
5136
5137 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5138 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5139 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5140 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5141 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5142
5143 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5144 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5145 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5146 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5147 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005148 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5149 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5150 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5151
5152 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5153 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5154 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5155
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005156 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5157 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5158 checked in multiple backends.
5159
5160 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5161 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5162
5163 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5164 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5165 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5166 one fails.
5167
5168 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5169 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5170 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5171
5172 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5173 server's queue.
5174
5175 Example of a header received by the application server :
5176 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5177 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5178
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005179 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5180 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005181
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005182
5183http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005184 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5186 yes | no | yes | yes
5187
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005188 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005189 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5190 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5191 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5192 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5193 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5194 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5195 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5196 and '-'.
5197
5198 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5199
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005200 Examples :
5201 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005202
5203
5204http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005205 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5207 yes | no | yes | yes
5208
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005209 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005210 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5211 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5212 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5213 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5214 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5215 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5216 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5217 and '-'.
5218
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005219 Examples :
5220 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005222
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005223http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5224 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5225 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5226 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5227 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5229 yes | yes | yes | yes
5230 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005231 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005232 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005233 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5234 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005235
5236 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5237 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5238 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5239 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5240
5241 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5242 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5243 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5244 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5245
5246 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5247 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5248 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5249 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5250 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5251 chroot is performed.
5252
5253 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5254 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5255 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5256 considered.
5257
5258 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5259 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5260 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5261 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5262 considered as a raw string.
5263
5264 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5265 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5266 "content-type".
5267
5268 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5269 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5270 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5271 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5272 evaluated as a log-format string.
5273
5274 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5275 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5276 argument to "content-type".
5277
5278 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5279 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5280 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5281 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5282
5283 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5284 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5285 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5286 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5287 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5288 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5289 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5290 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5291
5292 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5293 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5294 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5295
5296 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5297 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5298
5299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005300http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005301 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5302
5303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 no | yes | yes | yes
5305
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005306 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5307 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5308 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5309 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5310 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005312 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5313 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005315 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005317 Example:
5318 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5319 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5320 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005322 http-request allow if nagios
5323 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5324 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5325 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005327 Example:
5328 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5329 acl add path /addacl
5330 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005332 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005334 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5335 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005337 Example:
5338 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5339 acl setmap path /setmap
5340 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005342 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005344 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5345 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005347 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5348 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005350http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005352 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5353 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5354 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5355 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5356 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5357 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5358 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5359 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005361http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005363 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5364 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5365 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5366 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5367 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5368 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5369 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5370 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005372http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005374 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5375 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005376
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005378http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005380 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5381 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5382 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5383 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5384 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005385
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005386 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5387 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5388 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5389 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5390 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5391 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5392 instead.
5393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005394 Example:
5395 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5396 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005397
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005398http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005399
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005400 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005402http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5403 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005405 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5406 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5407 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5408 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5409 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5410 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5411 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5412 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5413 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005415 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5416 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5417 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005418 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5419
5420 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5421 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5422 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5423 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005424
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005425http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005427 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5428 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5429 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5430 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5431 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5432 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005434http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005436 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005438http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005440 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5441 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5442 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5443 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5444 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5445 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005446
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005447http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5448http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5449 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5450 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5451 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005453
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005454 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5455 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5456 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005457 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005458 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5459 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5460 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005461 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005462 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005463
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005464http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5465 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5466 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5467 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5468
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005469http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5470
5471 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5472 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5473 pointed by <resolvers>.
5474 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5475 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5476 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5477 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5478 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5479 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5480 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5481 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5482 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5483 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5484 to 0.0.0.0.
5485
5486 Example:
5487 resolvers mydns
5488 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5489 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5490 timeout retry 1s
5491 hold valid 10s
5492 hold nx 3s
5493 hold other 3s
5494 hold obsolete 0s
5495 accepted_payload_size 8192
5496
5497 frontend fe
5498 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5499 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5500 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5501
5502 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5503 # which mean DNS resolution error
5504 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5505
5506 default_backend be
5507
5508 backend b_503
5509 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5510 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5511 # 503 error page to end users
5512
5513 backend be
5514 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5515 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5516 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5517 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5518 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5519
5520 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5521 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5522
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005523http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5524
5525 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5526 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5527 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5528 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005529 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5530 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005531
5532 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005534http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005536 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5537 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5538 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5539 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5540 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005542http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005544 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5545 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5546 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5547 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005549http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5550 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005551
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005552 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005553 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5554 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5555 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5556 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5557 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005558
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005559 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5560 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5561 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5562 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5563 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005564
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005565 Example:
5566 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5567
5568 # applied to:
5569 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5570
5571 # outputs:
5572 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5573
5574 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005575
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005576 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5577
5578 # applied to:
5579 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005580
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005581 # outputs:
5582 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005583
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005584http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5585 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5586
5587 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5588 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005589 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5590 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5591 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005592
5593 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5594 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5595 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5596
5597 Example:
5598 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5599 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5600
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005601 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5602 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5603 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5604 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5605
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005606http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5607 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5608
5609 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5610 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5611 query-string are replaced.
5612
5613 Example:
5614 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5615 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5616
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005617http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5618 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5619
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005620 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5621 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5622 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5623 against.
5624
5625 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5626 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5627 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005628
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005629 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5630 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5631 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5632 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5633 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5634 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5635 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5636 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5637 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005638 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5639 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005640
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005641 Example:
5642 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5643 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005644
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005645 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5646 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005648http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5649 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005650
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005651 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5652 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5653 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5654 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005655
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005656 Example:
5657 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005658
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005659 # applied to:
5660 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005661
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005662 # outputs:
5663 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005664
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005665http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5666 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5667 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005668 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005669 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5670
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005671 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005672 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5673 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005674 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005675 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005676 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005677 are followed to create the response :
5678
5679 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5680 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5681 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5682 ignored.
5683
5684 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5685 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005686 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005687 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5688 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005689
5690 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5691 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5692 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005693 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005694 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005695
5696 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5697 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5698 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005699 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005700 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5701 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005702
5703 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5704 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5705 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5706 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5707 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5708 as a raw content.
5709
5710 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5711 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5712 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5713 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5714 considered as a raw string.
5715
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005716 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5717 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5718 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5719 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5720
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005721 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5722 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005723 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005724
5725 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5726
5727 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005728 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005729 if { path /ping }
5730
5731 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5732 if { path /favicon.ico }
5733
5734 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5735 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5736 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005738http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5739http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005741 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5742 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5743 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005744
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005745http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5746 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005747
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005748 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5749 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5750 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5751 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005753http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005755 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5756 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5757 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5758 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5759 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005761 Arguments:
5762 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5763 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005765 Example:
5766 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5767 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005769 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5770 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005772http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005774 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5775 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5776 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005778 Arguments:
5779 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5780 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005782 Example:
5783 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5784 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005785
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005786 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5787 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5788 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005790http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005791
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005792 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5793 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5794 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5795 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5796 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005798 Example:
5799 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5800 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5801 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5802 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5803 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5804 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5805 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5806 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5807 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005809http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005811 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5812 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5813 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5814 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5815 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005817http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5818 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005820 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5821 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5822 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5823 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5824 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5825 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5826 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5827 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5828 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005829
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005830http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005832 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5833 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5834 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5835 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5836 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5837 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5838 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005840http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005841
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005842 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5843 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5844 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005845
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005846http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005848 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5849 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5850 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5851 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5852 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5853 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5854 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5855 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005857http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005859 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5860 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5861 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5862 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5863 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5864 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005865
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005866 Example :
5867 # prepend the host name before the path
5868 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005869
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005870http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5871
5872 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
5873 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
5874 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
5875
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005876http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005878 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5879 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5880 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5881 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5882 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005884http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005885
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005886 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5887 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5888 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5889 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5890 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5891 values have higher priority.
5892 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5893 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5894 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5895 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5896 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005898http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005899
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005900 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5901 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5902 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5903 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5904 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5905 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5906 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005907
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005908 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005909
5910 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005911 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5912 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005914http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5915 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5916 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5917 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005918 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5919 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920
5921 Arguments :
5922 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5923 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005924
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005925 See also "option forwardfor".
5926
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005927 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005928 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5929 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5930
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005931 # After the masking this will track connections
5932 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5933 http-request track-sc0 src
5934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005935 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5936 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5937
5938http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5939
5940 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5941 expression.
5942
5943 Arguments:
5944 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5945 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005946
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005947 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005948 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5949 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5950
5951 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5952 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5953 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5954
5955http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5956
5957 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5958 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5959 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5960 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5961 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5962 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5963 information from the request.
5964
5965 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5966
5967http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5968
5969 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5970 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5971 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5972 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5973 path and the query string.
5974 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5975
5976http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5977
5978 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5979 inline.
5980
5981 Arguments:
5982 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5983 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5984 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5985 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5986 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5987 (request and response)
5988 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5989 processing
5990 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5991 processing
5992 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5993 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5994 and '_'.
5995
5996 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5997 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005998
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005999 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006000 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006002http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6003 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006004
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006005 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6006 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6007 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6008 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6009 agent name must be used.
6010
6011 Arguments:
6012 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6013
6014 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6015 configuration.
6016
6017http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6018
6019 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6020 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6021 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6022 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6023 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6024 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6025 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6026 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6027 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6028 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6029 action.
6030 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6031 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6032 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6033 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6034 you fully understand how it works.
6035
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006036http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6037
6038 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6039 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6040 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6041 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6042 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006043 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006044 processing.
6045
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006046 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006047 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6048 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6049 rules evaluation.
6050
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006051http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6052http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6053 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6054 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6055 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6056 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006057
6058 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6059 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6060 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006061 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6062 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6063 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6064 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6065 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6066 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6067 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6068 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6069 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6070 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006071 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006072 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6073 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6074 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6075 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6076 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006077
6078http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6079http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6080http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6081
6082 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6083 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6084 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6085 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
6086 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
6087 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6088 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6089 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6090 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6091 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6092 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6093 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6094
6095 Arguments :
6096 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6097 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6098 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6099 select which table entry to update the counters.
6100
6101 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6102 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6103 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6104 that table until the session ends.
6105
6106 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6107 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6108 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6109 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6110 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6111 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6112 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6113 useful information.
6114
6115 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6116 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6117 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6118 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6119 checks that make use of it.
6120
6121http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6122
6123 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006124
6125 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006126 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006127
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006128http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6129
6130 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6131 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6132 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6133 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6134 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6135 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6136
6137 Arguments :
6138 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6139
6140 Example:
6141 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006143http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006145 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6146 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6147 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006148
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006149
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006150http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006151 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6152
6153 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6154 no | yes | yes | yes
6155
6156 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6157 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6158 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6159 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6160 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6161 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006163 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6164 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006166 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006167
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006168 Example:
6169 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006170
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006171 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006173 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6174 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006176 Example:
6177 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006179 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006181 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6182 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006184 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6185 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006187http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006189 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6190 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6191 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6192 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6193 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6194 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6195 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6196 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006198http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006200 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6201 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6202 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6203 example, or to pass some internal information.
6204 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6205 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6206 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006208http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006210 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6211 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006212
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006213http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006214
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006215 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006217http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006219 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6220 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6221 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6222 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6223 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6224 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6225 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006226
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006227 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6228 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6229 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6230 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6231 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006232
6233 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6234 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6235 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6236 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006237
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006238http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006239
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006240 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6241 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6242 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6243 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6244 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6245 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006246
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006247http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006249 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006250
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006251http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006252
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006253 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6254 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6255 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6256 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6257 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6258 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006259
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006260http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6261http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6262 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6263 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6264 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6265 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006266
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006267 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6268 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6269 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006270 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006271 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6272 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6273 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006274 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006275 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006276
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006277http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006278
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006279 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6280 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6281 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6282 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6283 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6284 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006285
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006286http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6287 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006288
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006289 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6290 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006291
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006292 Example:
6293 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006294
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006295 # applied to:
6296 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006297
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006298 # outputs:
6299 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006300
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006301 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006303http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6304 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006305
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006306 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006307 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006308
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006309 Example:
6310 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006311
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006312 # applied to:
6313 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006314
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006315 # outputs:
6316 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006317
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006318http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6319 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6320 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006321 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006322 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6323
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006324 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006325 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6326 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006327 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006328 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006329 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006330 are followed to create the response :
6331
6332 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6333 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6334 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6335 ignored.
6336
6337 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6338 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006339 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006340 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6341 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006342
6343 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6344 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6345 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006346 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006347 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006348
6349 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6350 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6351 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006352 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006353 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6354 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006355
6356 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6357 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6358 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6359 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6360 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6361 as a raw content.
6362
6363 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6364 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6365 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6366 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6367 considered as a raw string.
6368
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006369 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6370 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6371 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6372 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6373
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006374 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6375 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006376 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006377
6378 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6379
6380 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006381 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006382 if { status eq 404 }
6383
6384 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6385 string "This is the end !" \
6386 if { status eq 500 }
6387
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006388http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6389http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006391 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6392 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6393 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006394
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006395http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6396 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006397
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006398 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6399 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6400 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6401 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006402
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006403http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006404
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006405 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6406 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6407 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6408 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6409 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006410
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006411 Arguments:
6412 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006413
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006414 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6415 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006416
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006417http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006418
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006419 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6420 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6421 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006422
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006423http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6424
6425 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6426 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6427 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6428 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6429 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6430
6431http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6432
6433 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6434 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6435 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6436 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6437 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6438 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6439 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6440 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6441 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6442
6443http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6444
6445 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6446 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6447 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6448 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6449 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6450 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6451 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6452
6453http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6454
6455 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6456 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6457 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6458 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6459 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6460 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6461 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6462 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6463
6464http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6465 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6466
6467 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6468 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6469 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6470 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006471
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006472 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006473 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6474 http-response set-status 431
6475 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6476 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006477
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006478http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006479
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006480 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6481 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6482 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6483 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6484 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6485 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6486 based on some information from the request.
6487
6488 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6489
6490http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6491
6492 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6493 inline.
6494
6495 Arguments:
6496 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6497 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6498 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6499 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6500 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6501 (request and response)
6502 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6503 processing
6504 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6505 processing
6506 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6507 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6508 and '_'.
6509
6510 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6511 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006512
6513 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006514 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006515
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006516http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006517
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006518 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6519 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6520 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6521 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6522 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6523 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6524 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6525 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6526 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6527 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6528 action.
6529 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6530 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6531 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6532 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6533 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006534
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006535http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6536
6537 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6538 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6539 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6540 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6541 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006542 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006543 processing.
6544
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006545 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006546 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006547 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006548 rules evaluation.
6549
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006550http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6551http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6552http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006553
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006554 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6555 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6556 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6557 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6558 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6559 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6560
6561http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6562
6563 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6564 about <var-name>.
6565
6566 Example:
6567 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6568
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006569
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006570http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6571 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6572
6573 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6574 yes | no | yes | yes
6575
6576 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006577 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6578 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6579 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006580
6581 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6582
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006583 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6584 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6585 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6586 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6587 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6588 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6589 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6590 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6591 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6592 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006593
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006594 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6595 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6596 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6597 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6598 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6599 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6600 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6601 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006602
6603 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6604 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6605 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6606 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6607 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6608 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6609 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6610 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006611 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006612 downsides of rare connection failures.
6613
6614 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6615 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6616 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6617 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6618 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6619 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006620 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006621 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6622 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6623 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6624 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6625 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6626
6627 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006628 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6629 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6630 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006631
6632 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006633 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006634
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006635 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6636 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006637
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006638 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006639
6640 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6641 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6642 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6643
6644 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6645
6646
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006647http-send-name-header [<header>]
6648 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6650 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006651 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006652 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6653
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006654 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6655 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6656 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6657 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6658 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6659 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6660 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6661 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6662 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6663 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6664 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6665 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6666 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6667 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6668 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6669 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006670
6671 See also : "server"
6672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006673id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006674 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6676 no | yes | yes | yes
6677 Arguments : none
6678
6679 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6680 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6681 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006682
6683
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006684ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6685 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6686 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006687 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006688
6689 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6690 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6691 and running).
6692
6693 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6694 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6695 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006696 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006697 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6698
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006699 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6700 "unless" condition is met.
6701
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006702 Example:
6703 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6704 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6705 ignore-persist if url_static
6706
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006707 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6708
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006709load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6710 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6711 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 yes | no | yes | yes
6713
6714 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6715 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6716 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006717 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006718 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6719 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6720 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6721 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6722
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006723 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006724 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006725 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006726
6727 Arguments:
6728 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6729 named "server-state-file".
6730
6731 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6732 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6733 name is used as a file name.
6734
6735 none don't load any stat for this backend
6736
6737 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006738 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6739 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6740 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006741 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006742 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006743
6744 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6745 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6746
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006747 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006748
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006749 global
6750 stats socket /tmp/socket
6751 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006752
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006753 defaults
6754 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006755
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006756 backend bk
6757 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6758 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006759
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006760
6761 Then one can run :
6762
6763 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6764
6765 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6766
6767 1
6768 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6769 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6770 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6771
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006772 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006773
6774 global
6775 stats socket /tmp/socket
6776 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6777
6778 defaults
6779 load-server-state-from-file local
6780
6781 backend bk
6782 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6783 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6784
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006785
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006786 Then one can run :
6787
6788 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6789
6790 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6791
6792 1
6793 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6794 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6795 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6796
6797 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6798 "show servers state"
6799
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006800
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006801log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006802log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6803 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006804no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006805 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6807 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006808
6809 Prefix :
6810 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6811 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6812 prefix does not allow arguments.
6813
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006814 Arguments :
6815 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6816 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6817 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6818 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6819 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6820 parameter.
6821
6822 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6823 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6824
6825 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6826 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6827 standard syslog port).
6828
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006829 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6830 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6831 standard syslog port).
6832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006833 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6834 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6835 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006836 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006837
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006838 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6839 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6840 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6841 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6842 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6843 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6844 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6845 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6846 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6847 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6848 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6849 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6850 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6851 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6852 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6853 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006854 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6855 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006856
6857 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6858 and "fd@2", see above.
6859
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006860 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6861 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6862 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6863 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6864 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6865 having the logs instantly available.
6866
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6868 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6871 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6872 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6873 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6874 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6875 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6876 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6877 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6878 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6879 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006880 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006881
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006882 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6883 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6884 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6885 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6886 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6887
6888 <sample_size>
6889 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6890 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6891 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6892 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6893 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6894
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006895 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6896 one of the following :
6897
6898 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6899 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6900
6901 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6902 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6903
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006904 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6905 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6906 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6907 designed to be used with a local log server.
6908
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006909 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6910 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6911 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6912 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6913 systemd logger consumes.
6914
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006915 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6916 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6917 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6918 used with a local log server.
6919
6920 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6921 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6922 designed to be used with a local log server.
6923
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006924 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6925 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6926 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6927 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6928
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006929 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6930
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006931 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6932 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6933 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6934
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006935 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6936 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6937 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6938 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006939
6940 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6941 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6942 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006943 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6944 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6945 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6946 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6947 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006948
6949 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6950
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006951 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6952 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6953 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006954
6955 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6956 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6957 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6958 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6959
6960 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6961 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006962
6963 Example :
6964 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006965 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6966 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6967 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006968 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6969 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006970 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006971
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006972
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006973log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006974 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6976 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006977
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006978 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6979 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6980 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6981 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6982 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006983
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006984 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6985 "option httplog" directives.
6986
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006987log-format-sd <string>
6988 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6990 yes | yes | yes | no
6991
6992 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6993 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6994 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6995 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6996 which covers the log format string in depth.
6997
6998 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6999 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7000
7001 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7002 log format to "rfc5424".
7003
7004 Example :
7005 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7006
7007
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007008log-tag <string>
7009 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7011 yes | yes | yes | yes
7012
7013 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7014 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7015 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7016 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7017 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7018 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7019 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7020 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7021 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007022
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007023max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7024 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7026 yes | no | yes | yes
7027
7028 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7029 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7030 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7031 servers.
7032
7033 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7034 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7035 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7036 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7037 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007038 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007039 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7040 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7041 picking a different server.
7042
7043 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7044 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7045 even if they have to be queued.
7046
7047 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7048 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7049
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007050max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7051 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7052 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7053 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007054
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007055maxconn <conns>
7056 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7058 yes | yes | yes | no
7059 Arguments :
7060 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7061 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7062 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7063 closes.
7064
7065 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7066 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7067 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7068 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007069 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7070 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7071 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7072 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007073
7074 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7075 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7076 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7077
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007078 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7079 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007080
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007081 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7082
7083
7084mode { tcp|http|health }
7085 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7087 yes | yes | yes | yes
7088 Arguments :
7089 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7090 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7091 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7092 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7093
7094 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7095 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7096 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7097 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7098 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7099
7100 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007101 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
7102 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
7103 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
7104 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
7105 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
7106 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
7107 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007108
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007109 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7110 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7111 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007112
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007113 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007114 defaults http_instances
7115 mode http
7116
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007117 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007118
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007119
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007120monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007121 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007124 Arguments :
7125 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7126 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007127 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007128 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7129 backend and its backup.
7130
7131 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7132 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7133 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7134 servers in a list of backends.
7135
7136 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7137 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7138 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7139 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7140 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7141 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7142 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007143 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7144 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007145
7146 Example:
7147 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007148 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007149 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7150 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7151 monitor-uri /site_alive
7152 monitor fail if site_dead
7153
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007154 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007155
7156
7157monitor-net <source>
7158 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
7159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7160 yes | yes | yes | no
7161 Arguments :
7162 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
7163 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
7164 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
7165 followed by a mask.
7166
7167 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
7168 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007169 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007170 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
7171
7172 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
7173 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
7174 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
7175 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007176 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
7177 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
7178 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007179
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007180 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
7181 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
7182 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
7183 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
7184 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
7185 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007186
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01007187 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
7188 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007189
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007190 Example :
7191 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
7192 frontend www
7193 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
7194
7195 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
7196
7197
7198monitor-uri <uri>
7199 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7201 yes | yes | yes | no
7202 Arguments :
7203 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7204 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7205
7206 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7207 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7208 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7209 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7210 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7211 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7212 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7213 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7214
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007215 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007216 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7217 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7218 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7219 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7220 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7221 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007222
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007223 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7224 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7225 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7226 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7227
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007228 Example :
7229 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7230 frontend www
7231 mode http
7232 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7233
7234 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
7235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007236
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007237option abortonclose
7238no option abortonclose
7239 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7241 yes | no | yes | yes
7242 Arguments : none
7243
7244 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7245 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7246 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7247 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007248 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007249 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7250 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7251 encountered while delivering the response.
7252
7253 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7254 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7255 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7256 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7257 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7258 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007259 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007260 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007261 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007262 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7263 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7264 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7265
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007266 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7267 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007268 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7269 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7270 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7271 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7272 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7273 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007274 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007275
7276 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7277 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7278
7279 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7280
7281
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007282option accept-invalid-http-request
7283no option accept-invalid-http-request
7284 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7286 yes | yes | yes | no
7287 Arguments : none
7288
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007289 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007290 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007291 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007292 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7293 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7294 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7295 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7296 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007297 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7298 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7299 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7300 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007301 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007302 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007303 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7304 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7305 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007306
7307 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7308 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7309 been confirmed.
7310
7311 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7312 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007313 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7314 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007315 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7316
7317 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7318 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7319
7320 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7321 stats socket.
7322
7323
7324option accept-invalid-http-response
7325no option accept-invalid-http-response
7326 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7328 yes | no | yes | yes
7329 Arguments : none
7330
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007331 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007332 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007333 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007334 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7335 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7336 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7337 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7338 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007339 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7340 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7341 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007342
7343 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7344 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7345 been confirmed.
7346
7347 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7348 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7349 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7350 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7351
7352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7354
7355 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7356 stats socket.
7357
7358
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007359option allbackups
7360no option allbackups
7361 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7363 yes | no | yes | yes
7364 Arguments : none
7365
7366 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7367 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7368 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7369 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7370 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7371 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7372 order between the backup servers anymore.
7373
7374 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7375 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7376
7377 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7378 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7379
7380
7381option checkcache
7382no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007383 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7385 yes | no | yes | yes
7386 Arguments : none
7387
7388 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7389 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007390 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007391 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7392 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007393 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007394
7395 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007396 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007397 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007398 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7399 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007400 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007401 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007402 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7403 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007404 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007405 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7406 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007407 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007408 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7409 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7410 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7411 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7412 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7413 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7414 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7415 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7416 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7417
7418 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007419 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7420 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7421 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7422 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007423
7424 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7425 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007426 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007427 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007428
7429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7431
7432
7433option clitcpka
7434no option clitcpka
7435 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7437 yes | yes | yes | no
7438 Arguments : none
7439
7440 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7441 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007442 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007443 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7444
7445 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7446 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7447 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7448 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7449
7450 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7451 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7452 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7453 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7454 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7455
7456 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7457
7458 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7459 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7460 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7461
7462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7464
7465 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7466
7467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007468option contstats
7469 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7471 yes | yes | yes | no
7472 Arguments : none
7473
7474 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7475 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7476 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7477 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007478 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7479 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7480 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7481 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7482 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007483
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007484option disable-h2-upgrade
7485no option disable-h2-upgrade
7486 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7487 connection.
7488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7489 yes | yes | yes | no
7490 Arguments : none
7491
7492 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7493 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7494 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7495 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7496 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7497 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7498 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7499 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7500
7501 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7502 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007503
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007504option dontlog-normal
7505no option dontlog-normal
7506 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7508 yes | yes | yes | no
7509 Arguments : none
7510
7511 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7512 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7513 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7514 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7515 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7516 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7517 logged.
7518
7519 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7520 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7521 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007523 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007524 logging.
7525
7526
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007527option dontlognull
7528no option dontlognull
7529 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7531 yes | yes | yes | no
7532 Arguments : none
7533
7534 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7535 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7536 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7537 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7538 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7539 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007540 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7541 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7542 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007543
7544 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007545 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007546 would not be logged.
7547
7548 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7549 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7550
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007551 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7552 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007553
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007554
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007555option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007556 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7558 yes | yes | yes | yes
7559 Arguments :
7560 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7561 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007562 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007563 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007564
7565 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7566 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7567 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7568 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7569 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7570 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7571 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007572 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7573 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7574 possible that the client has already brought one.
7575
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007576 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007577 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007578 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007579 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007580 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007581 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007582
7583 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7584 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7585 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7586 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7587 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7588 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7589 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7590
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007591 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7592 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7593 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7594 are under the control of the end-user.
7595
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007596 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007597 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7598 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007599 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7600 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7601 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007602
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007603 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007604 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7605 frontend www
7606 mode http
7607 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7608
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007609 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7610 backend www
7611 mode http
7612 option forwardfor header X-Client
7613
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007614 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007615 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007616
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007617
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007618option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7619no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7620 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7622 yes | yes | yes | no
7623 Arguments : none
7624
7625 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7626 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7627 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7628 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7629 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7630 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7631 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7632
7633 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7634 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7635 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7636 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7637 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7638 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7639 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7640 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7641 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7642 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7643
7644 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7645
7646 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7647 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7648
7649 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7650 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7651
7652
7653option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7654no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7655 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7657 yes | no | yes | yes
7658 Arguments : none
7659
7660 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7661 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7662 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7663 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7664 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7665 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7666 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7667
7668 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7669 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7670 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7671 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7672 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7673 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7674 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7675 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7676 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7677 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7678
7679 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7680
7681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7683
7684 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7685 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7686
7687
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007688option http-buffer-request
7689no option http-buffer-request
7690 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7692 yes | yes | yes | yes
7693 Arguments : none
7694
7695 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7696 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7697 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7698 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7699 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7700 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007701 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7702 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7703 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7704 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007705
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007706 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007707
7708
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007709option http-ignore-probes
7710no option http-ignore-probes
7711 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7713 yes | yes | yes | no
7714 Arguments : none
7715
7716 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7717 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7718 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7719 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7720 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7721 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7722 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7723 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7724 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007725 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7726 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007727 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7728
7729 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7730 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7731 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7732 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7733 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7734 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7735 are often the only way to detect them.
7736
7737 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7738 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7739
7740 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7741
7742
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007743option http-keep-alive
7744no option http-keep-alive
7745 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7747 yes | yes | yes | yes
7748 Arguments : none
7749
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007750 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7751 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007752 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7753 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007754 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7755 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7756 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007757
7758 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7759 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007760 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7761 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7762 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7763 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7764 situations where this option may be useful :
7765
7766 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007767 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007768
7769 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7770 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7771
7772 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7773 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7774 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7775 request.
7776
7777 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7778 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007779 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7780 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7781 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007782
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007783 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7784 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7785 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7786 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7787 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7788 not set.
7789
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007790 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7791 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7792 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007793
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007794 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007795 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007796 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007797
7798
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007799option http-no-delay
7800no option http-no-delay
7801 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7803 yes | yes | yes | yes
7804 Arguments : none
7805
7806 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7807 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7808 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7809 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7810 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7811 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7812 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7813 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7814 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7815 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7816 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7817 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7818 affected.
7819
7820 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7821 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7822 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7823 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7824 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7825 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7826 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7827 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7828 latency environments.
7829
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007830 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7831
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007832
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007833option http-pretend-keepalive
7834no option http-pretend-keepalive
7835 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007837 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007838 Arguments : none
7839
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007840 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007841 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7842 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7843 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7844 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7845 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7846 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7847 consider the response complete.
7848
7849 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7850 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7851 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7852 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007853 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007854 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7855
7856 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7857 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7858 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7859 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7860 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7861 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7862 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7863
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007864 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7865 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7866 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7867 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7868 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7869 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007870
7871 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7872 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7873
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007874 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007875 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007876
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007877
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007878option http-server-close
7879no option http-server-close
7880 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7882 yes | yes | yes | yes
7883 Arguments : none
7884
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007885 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7886 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7887 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7888 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007889 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7890 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7891 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7892 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7893 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7894 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7895 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7896 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7897 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7898 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7899 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007900
7901 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7902 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7903 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7904 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007905 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7906 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007907
7908 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7909 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007910 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7911 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7912 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007913
7914 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7915 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7916
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007917 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7918 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007919
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007920option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007921no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007922 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7924 yes | yes | yes | no
7925 Arguments : none
7926
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007927 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007928 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7929 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7930 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7931 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7932 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7933 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7934
7935 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7936 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007937 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7938 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7939 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007940
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007941 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7942 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7943 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7944 front of an existing proxy.
7945
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007946 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7947
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007948 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007949
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007950option httpchk
7951option httpchk <uri>
7952option httpchk <method> <uri>
7953option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007954 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7956 yes | no | yes | yes
7957 Arguments :
7958 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7959 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7960 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7961 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7962 ones.
7963
7964 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7965 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7966 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7967
7968 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7969 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7970 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007971 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007972
7973 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7974 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7975 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7976 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7977 the lack of any response.
7978
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007979 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7980 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7981 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7982 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7983
7984 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7985 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7986 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007987
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007988 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7989 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007990 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007991 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007992 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007993
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007994 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7995 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7996 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7997 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7998
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007999 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008000 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8001 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8002 backend https_relay
8003 mode tcp
8004 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8005 http-check send hdr Host www
8006 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008007
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008008 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8009 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8010 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008011
8012
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008013option httpclose
8014no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008015 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8017 yes | yes | yes | yes
8018 Arguments : none
8019
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008020 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8021 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8022 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8023 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008024 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008025
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008026 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8027 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008028 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008029 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8030 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008031
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008032 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8033 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8034 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008035
8036 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8037 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008038 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8039 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8040 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008041
8042 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8043 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8044
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008045 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008046
8047
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008048option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008049 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008051 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008052 Arguments :
8053 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8054 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8055 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008056 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008057 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008058
8059 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8060 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8061 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8062 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8063 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8064 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8065 ports.
8066
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008067 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8068 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008069
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008070 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008072 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008073
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008074
8075option http_proxy
8076no option http_proxy
8077 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8079 yes | yes | yes | yes
8080 Arguments : none
8081
8082 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8083 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8084 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8085 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8086 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8087
8088 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8089 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008090 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8091 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008092
8093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8095
8096 Example :
8097 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8098 backend direct_forward
8099 option httpclose
8100 option http_proxy
8101
8102 See also : "option httpclose"
8103
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008104
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008105option independent-streams
8106no option independent-streams
8107 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8109 yes | yes | yes | yes
8110 Arguments : none
8111
8112 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8113 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8114 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8115 receive data or not.
8116
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008117 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008118 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8119 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8120 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8121 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8122 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8123 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8124 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8125 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8126 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8127 socket buffers.
8128
8129 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8130 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8131 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8132 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8133 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8134
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008135 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008136
8137
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008138option ldap-check
8139 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8141 yes | no | yes | yes
8142 Arguments : none
8143
8144 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8145 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8146 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8147 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8148
8149 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8150 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8151
8152 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8153 configure it.
8154
8155 Example :
8156 option ldap-check
8157
8158 See also : "option httpchk"
8159
8160
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008161option external-check
8162 Use external processes for server health checks
8163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8164 yes | no | yes | yes
8165
8166 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8167 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8168 command".
8169
8170 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8171
8172 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8173
8174
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008175option log-health-checks
8176no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008177 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8179 yes | no | yes | yes
8180 Arguments : none
8181
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008182 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8183 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8184 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008185
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008186 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8187 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8188 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8189 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8190 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008192 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008193 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008194
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008195 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8196 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8197 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008198
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008199
8200option log-separate-errors
8201no option log-separate-errors
8202 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8204 yes | yes | yes | no
8205 Arguments : none
8206
8207 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8208 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8209 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8210 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8211 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8212 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8213 provides very important information.
8214
8215 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8216 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8217 error logs.
8218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008219 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008220 logging.
8221
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008222
8223option logasap
8224no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008225 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8227 yes | yes | yes | no
8228 Arguments : none
8229
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008230 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8231 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8232 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8233 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8234
8235 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8236 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8237 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8238 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8239 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008240 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008241 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8242 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8243 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8244 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008245 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008246
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008247 Examples :
8248 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8249 mode http
8250 option httplog
8251 option logasap
8252 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8253
8254 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8255 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8256 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8257 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008259 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008260 logging.
8261
8262
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008263option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008264 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8266 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008267 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008268 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8269 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008270 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8271 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008272
8273 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8274 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008275 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008276 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8277 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8278 in the MySQL table, like this :
8279
8280 USE mysql;
8281 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8282 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8283
8284 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008285 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008286 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8287 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8288 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8289 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8290 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8291 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8292 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8293
8294 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8295 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008296
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008297 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008298
8299 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8300 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8301 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8302 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008303 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8304 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008305
8306 See also: "option httpchk"
8307
8308
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008309option nolinger
8310no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008311 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8313 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008314 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008315
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008316 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008317 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8318 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8319 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8320 connections.
8321
8322 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8323 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8324 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8325 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8326 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8327 this too.
8328
8329 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8330 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8331 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8332
8333 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8334 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8335 for servers.
8336
8337 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8338 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8339
8340
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008341option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8342 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8344 yes | yes | yes | yes
8345 Arguments :
8346 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8347 matching <network>
8348 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8349 header name.
8350
8351 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8352 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8353 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8354 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8355 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8356 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8357 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8358 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8359 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8360 possible that the client has already brought one.
8361
8362 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8363 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8364 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8365 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8366 header and requires different one.
8367
8368 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8369 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8370 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8371 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8372 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8373 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8374 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8375
8376 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8377 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8378 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8379 both are defined.
8380
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008381 Examples :
8382 # Original Destination address
8383 frontend www
8384 mode http
8385 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8386
8387 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8388 backend www
8389 mode http
8390 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8391
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008392 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008393
8394
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008395option persist
8396no option persist
8397 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8399 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008400 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008401
8402 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8403 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8404 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8405 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8406 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8407 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8408 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8409 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8410 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8411 redirected to another valid server.
8412
8413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8415
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008416 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008417
8418
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008419option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8420 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8422 yes | no | yes | yes
8423 Arguments :
8424 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8425 PostgreSQL server.
8426
8427 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8428 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8429 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8430 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8431
8432 See also: "option httpchk"
8433
8434
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008435option prefer-last-server
8436no option prefer-last-server
8437 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8438 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8439 yes | no | yes | yes
8440 Arguments : none
8441
8442 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8443 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8444 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8445 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8446 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8447 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8448 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8449 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8450 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008451 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8452 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008453 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8454 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8455 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008456 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8457 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8458 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008459
8460 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8461 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8462
8463 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8464
8465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008466option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008467option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008468no option redispatch
8469 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8470 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8471 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008472 Arguments :
8473 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8474 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8475 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008476 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008477 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008478 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008479 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8480 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8481 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008483
8484 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8485 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8486 be able to access the service anymore.
8487
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008488 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8489 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008490
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008491 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8492 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8493 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8494 following order:
8495
8496 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8497
8498 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8499 list, or
8500
8501 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8502
8503 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8504 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8505
8506 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8507 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8508 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8509 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8510
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008511 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008512 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8513 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008515 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8516 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8517
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008518 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008519
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008520
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008521option redis-check
8522 Use redis health checks for server testing
8523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8524 yes | no | yes | yes
8525 Arguments : none
8526
8527 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8528 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8529 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8530 find the "+PONG" response message.
8531
8532 Example :
8533 option redis-check
8534
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008535 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008536
8537
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008538option smtpchk
8539option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8540 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8542 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008543 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008544 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008545 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008546 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8547
8548 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8549 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8550 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8551
8552 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8553 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8554 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8555 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8556 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8557 dead server.
8558
8559 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8560 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008561 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008562 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8563
8564 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8565 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8566 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8567 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008568 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008569
8570 Example :
8571 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8572
8573 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008575
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008576option socket-stats
8577no option socket-stats
8578
8579 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8581 yes | yes | yes | no
8582
8583 Arguments : none
8584
8585
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008586option splice-auto
8587no option splice-auto
8588 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8590 yes | yes | yes | yes
8591 Arguments : none
8592
8593 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8594 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008595 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008596 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008597 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008598 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8599 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8600 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8601 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8602
8603 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8604 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8605 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8606 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8607 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8608 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8609 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8610 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8611 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8612 keyword.
8613
8614 Example :
8615 option splice-auto
8616
8617 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8618 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8619
8620 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8621 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8622
8623
8624option splice-request
8625no option splice-request
8626 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8628 yes | yes | yes | yes
8629 Arguments : none
8630
8631 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008632 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008633 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8634 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8635 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8636 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8637
8638 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8639
8640 Example :
8641 option splice-request
8642
8643 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8644 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8645
8646 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8647 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8648
8649
8650option splice-response
8651no option splice-response
8652 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8654 yes | yes | yes | yes
8655 Arguments : none
8656
8657 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008658 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008659 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8660 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8661 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8662 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8663
8664 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8665
8666 Example :
8667 option splice-response
8668
8669 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8670 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8671
8672 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8673 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8674
8675
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008676option spop-check
8677 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8679 no | no | no | yes
8680 Arguments : none
8681
8682 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8683 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8684 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8685 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8686
8687 Example :
8688 option spop-check
8689
8690 See also : "option httpchk"
8691
8692
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008693option srvtcpka
8694no option srvtcpka
8695 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8697 yes | no | yes | yes
8698 Arguments : none
8699
8700 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8701 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008702 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008703 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8704
8705 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8706 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8707 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8708 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8709
8710 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8711 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8712 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8713 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8714 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8715
8716 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8717
8718 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8719 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8720 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8721
8722 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8723 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8724
8725 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8726
8727
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008728option ssl-hello-chk
8729 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8731 yes | no | yes | yes
8732 Arguments : none
8733
8734 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8735 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8736 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8737 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8738 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8739 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8740 hello message.
8741
8742 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8743 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8744 messages, which is appreciable.
8745
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008746 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8747 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8748 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008749
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008750 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8751
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008752
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008753option tcp-check
8754 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8755 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8756 yes | no | yes | yes
8757
8758 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8759 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8760
8761 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8762 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8763 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8764
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008765 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008766 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8767 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8768 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8769 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8770 only.
8771
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008772 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008773 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8774 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8775 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8776 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8777
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008778 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008779 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8780 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008781 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008782 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8783 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8784 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8785 the respective protocols.
8786 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008787 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008788
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008789 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008790
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008791 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8792 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8793 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8794 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008795
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008796 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8797 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8798 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008799
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008800
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008801 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008802 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008803 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008804 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008805
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008806 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008807 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008808 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008809
8810 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8811 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008812 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008813 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008814 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008815 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008816 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008817 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008818 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8819 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008820 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008821 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8822 tcp-check expect string +OK
8823
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008824 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008825 (send many headers before analyzing)
8826 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008827 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008828 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8829 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8830 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8831 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008832 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008833
8834
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008835 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008836
8837
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008838option tcp-smart-accept
8839no option tcp-smart-accept
8840 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8842 yes | yes | yes | no
8843 Arguments : none
8844
8845 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8846 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8847 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8848 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8849 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8850 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8851
8852 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8853 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8854 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8855 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8856
8857 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8858 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8859 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008860 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008861
8862 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8863 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8864 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8865
8866 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8867 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8868 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8869
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008870 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8871
8872
8873option tcp-smart-connect
8874no option tcp-smart-connect
8875 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8877 yes | no | yes | yes
8878 Arguments : none
8879
8880 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8881 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8882 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8883 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8884 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8885
8886 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8887 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8888 complex.
8889
8890 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8891 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8892 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8893
8894 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8895 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8896
8897 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8898
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008899
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008900option tcpka
8901 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8903 yes | yes | yes | yes
8904 Arguments : none
8905
8906 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8907 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008908 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008909 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8910
8911 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8912 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8913 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8914 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8915
8916 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8917 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8918 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8919 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8920 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8921
8922 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8923
8924 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8925 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8926 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8927 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8928 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8929 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8930 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8931 backends.
8932
8933 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8934
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008935
8936option tcplog
8937 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008939 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008940 Arguments : none
8941
8942 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8943 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8944 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8945 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8946 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8947 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8948 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8949 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8950
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008951 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008953 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008954
8955
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008956option transparent
8957no option transparent
8958 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008960 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008961 Arguments : none
8962
8963 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8964 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8965 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8966 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8967 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8968 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8969 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8970 appropriate server.
8971
8972 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8973 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8974
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008975 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008976 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008977
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008978
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008979external-check command <command>
8980 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8982 yes | no | yes | yes
8983
8984 Arguments :
8985 <command> is the external command to run
8986
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008987 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8988
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008989 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008990
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008991 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8992 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8993 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8994 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8995 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8996 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008997
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008998 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8999
9000 Environment variables :
9001 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9002 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9003
9004 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9005
9006 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9007
9008 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9009 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9010 for a UNIX socket).
9011
9012 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9013
9014 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9015
9016 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9017
9018 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9019
9020 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9021
9022 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9023 socket).
9024
9025 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9026 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9027
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009028 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9029
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009030 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9031 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9032 failed.
9033
9034 Example :
9035 external-check command /bin/true
9036
9037 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9038
9039
9040external-check path <path>
9041 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9043 yes | no | yes | yes
9044
9045 Arguments :
9046 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9047
9048 The default path is "".
9049
9050 Example :
9051 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9052
9053 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9054 "external-check command"
9055
9056
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009057persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009058persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009059 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9061 yes | no | yes | yes
9062 Arguments :
9063 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009064 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9065 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009066
9067 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9068 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009069 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009070 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9071 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9072 forwarded to this server.
9073
9074 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9075 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9076 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009077 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009078 a single "listen" section.
9079
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009080 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9081 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9082 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9083
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009084 Example :
9085 listen tse-farm
9086 bind :3389
9087 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9088 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9089 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9090 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9091 persist rdp-cookie
9092 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009093 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009094 balance rdp-cookie
9095 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9096 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9097
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009098 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9099 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009100
9101
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009102rate-limit sessions <rate>
9103 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9105 yes | yes | yes | no
9106 Arguments :
9107 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9108 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9109
9110 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9111 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9112 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9113 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9114 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9115 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9116
9117 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9118 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9119 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9120 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9121
9122 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9123 listen smtp
9124 mode tcp
9125 bind :25
9126 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009127 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009128
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009129 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9130 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9131 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009132
9133 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9134
9135
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009136redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9137redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9138redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009139 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9141 no | yes | yes | yes
9142
9143 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009144 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009145
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009146 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009147 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009148 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9149 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9150 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009151
9152 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9153 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9154 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9155 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9156 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009157 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9158 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9159 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9160 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009161
9162 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9163 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9164 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9165 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9166 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9167 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009168 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009169 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009170 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9171 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9172 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009173
9174 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009175 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9176 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9177 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009178 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009179 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9180 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9181 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9182 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009183
9184 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009185 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009186
9187 - "drop-query"
9188 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9189 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9190 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9191 with a location-type redirect.
9192
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009193 - "append-slash"
9194 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9195 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9196 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9197 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9198
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009199 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9200 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9201 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9202 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9203 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9204 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9205 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9206
9207 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9208 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9209 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9210 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9211 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9212 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9213 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009214
9215 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9216 acl clear dst_port 80
9217 acl secure dst_port 8080
9218 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009219 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009220 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009221 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9222
9223 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009224 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9225 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9226 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009227 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009228
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009229 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9230 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9231 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9232
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009233 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009234 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009235
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009236 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009237 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9238 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9239 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009241 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009242
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009243
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009244retries <value>
9245 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9247 yes | no | yes | yes
9248 Arguments :
9249 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9250 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9251 default value is 3.
9252
9253 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9254 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9255 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9256
9257 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009258 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9259 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009260
9261 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9262 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9263
9264 See also : "option redispatch"
9265
9266
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009267retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009268 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9269 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9270 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9272 yes | no | yes | yes
9273 Arguments :
9274 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9275 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9276 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9277 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9278
9279 none never retry
9280
9281 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9282 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9283
9284 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9285 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9286 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9287 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9288 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9289 processing the request.
9290
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009291 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9292 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9293 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9294 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9295 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9296 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9297 overflow attack for example).
9298
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009299 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9300 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9301 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9302 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9303 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9304 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9305 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9306 amplify denial of service attacks.
9307
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009308 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9309 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9310 considered to be safe to retry.
9311
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009312 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9313 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9314 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9315 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9316
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009317 all-retryable-errors
9318 retry request for any error that are considered
9319 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9320 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9321 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9322
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009323 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9324 not cumulative.
9325
9326 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9327 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9328 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9329 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9330
9331 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9332 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9333 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9334 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9335 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9336 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9337 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9338 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9339 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9340 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9341 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9342 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9343
9344 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9345 should not use this directive.
9346
9347 The default is "conn-failure".
9348
9349 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9350
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009351server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009352 Declare a server in a backend
9353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9354 no | no | yes | yes
9355 Arguments :
9356 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009357 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009358 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009359
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009360 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9361 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9362 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9363 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009364 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9365 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9366 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9367 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9368 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009369 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9370 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9371 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9372 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9373 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9374 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9375 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009376 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009377 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9378 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9379 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9380 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9381 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9382 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009383 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9384 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009385 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9386 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009387
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009388 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009389 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9390 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9391 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9392 adding this value to the client's port.
9393
9394 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9395 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009396 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009397
9398 Examples :
9399 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9400 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009401 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009402 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9403 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9404 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009405
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009406 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9407 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9408 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9409 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9410 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9411
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009412 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9413 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009414
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009415server-state-file-name [<file>]
9416 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9417 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9418 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9419 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9420 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9421 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9422
9423 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9424 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9425
9426 global
9427 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9428
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009429 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009430 load-server-state-from-file
9431
9432 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9433 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009434
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009435server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9436 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9437 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9439 no | no | yes | yes
9440
9441 Arguments:
9442 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9443
9444 <num | range>
9445 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9446 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9447 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9448 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9449
9450 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9451
9452 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9453
9454 <params*>
9455 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9456 keyword.
9457
9458 Examples:
9459 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9460 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9461 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9462
9463 # or
9464 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9465
9466 # would be equivalent to:
9467 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9468 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9469 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9470
9471
9472
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009473source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009474source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009475source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009476 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9478 yes | no | yes | yes
9479 Arguments :
9480 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9481 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009482
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009483 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009484 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9485 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9486 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9487 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9488 supported prefixes are :
9489 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9490 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9491 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009492 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009493 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9494 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009495
9496 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9497 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009498 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9499 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9500 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009501
9502 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9503 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9504 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9505 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9506 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9507 <addr>.
9508
9509 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9510 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9511 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9512 port.
9513
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009514 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9515 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9516 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9517 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009518 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009519 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9520 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9521 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9522 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9523 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9524 HTTP header.
9525
9526 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9527 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009528 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009529 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9530 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9531 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9532 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9533 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9534 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9535 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9536
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009537 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9538 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9539 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9540 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9541 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9542 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9543
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009544 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9545 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9546 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9547 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9548
9549 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9550 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9551 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9552 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9553 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9554 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9555
9556 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9557 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9558 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9559 there are two methods :
9560
9561 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9562 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9563 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9564 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9565 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9566 of the client ranges may be used.
9567
9568 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9569 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9570 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9571 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9572 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9573 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9574 same session.
9575
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009576 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9577 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9578 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009579 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009580
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009581 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9582
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009583 Examples :
9584 backend private
9585 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9586 source 192.168.1.200
9587
9588 backend transparent_ssl1
9589 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9590 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9591
9592 backend transparent_ssl2
9593 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9594 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9595 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9596
9597 backend transparent_ssl3
9598 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9599 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9600 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9601
9602 backend transparent_smtp
9603 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9604 # with Tproxy version 4.
9605 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9606
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009607 backend transparent_http
9608 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9609 # proxy.
9610 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009612 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009613 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9614
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009615
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009616srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9617 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9618 the connection on the server side.
9619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9620 yes | no | yes | yes
9621 Arguments :
9622 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9623
9624 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9625 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009626 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9627 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009628
9629 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9630
9631
9632srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9633 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9634 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9635 server side.
9636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9637 yes | no | yes | yes
9638 Arguments :
9639 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9640 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9641 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9642 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9643
9644 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9645 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009646 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9647 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009648
9649 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9650
9651
9652srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9653 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9655 yes | no | yes | yes
9656 Arguments :
9657 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9658 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9659 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9660 document.
9661
9662 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9663 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009664 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9665 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009666
9667 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9668
9669
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009670stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9671 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009673 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009674
9675 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9676 matched.
9677
9678 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9679 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9680
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009681 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9682 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009683 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009684
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009685 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9686 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9687 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9688 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009689
9690 Example :
9691 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9692 backend stats_localhost
9693 stats enable
9694 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9695
9696 Example :
9697 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9698 backend stats_auth
9699 stats enable
9700 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9701 stats admin if TRUE
9702
9703 Example :
9704 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9705 userlist stats-auth
9706 group admin users admin
9707 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9708 group readonly users haproxy
9709 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9710
9711 backend stats_auth
9712 stats enable
9713 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9714 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9715 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9716 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9717
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009718 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9719 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9720 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009721
9722
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009723stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9724 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009726 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009727 Arguments :
9728 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9729
9730 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9731
9732 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9733 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9734 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9735 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9736 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9737 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9738
9739 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9740 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9741 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009742 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009743
9744 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9745 report using "stats scope".
9746
9747 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9748 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9749 unobvious parameters.
9750
9751 Example :
9752 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9753 backend public_www
9754 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9755 stats enable
9756 stats hide-version
9757 stats scope .
9758 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009759 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009760 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9761 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9762
9763 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9764 backend private_monitoring
9765 stats enable
9766 stats uri /admin?stats
9767 stats refresh 5s
9768
9769 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9770
9771
9772stats enable
9773 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009775 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009776 Arguments : none
9777
9778 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9779 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9780 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9781 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9782 - stats auth : no authentication
9783 - stats scope : no restriction
9784
9785 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9786 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9787 unobvious parameters.
9788
9789 Example :
9790 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9791 backend public_www
9792 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9793 stats enable
9794 stats hide-version
9795 stats scope .
9796 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009797 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009798 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9799 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9800
9801 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9802 backend private_monitoring
9803 stats enable
9804 stats uri /admin?stats
9805 stats refresh 5s
9806
9807 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9808
9809
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009810stats hide-version
9811 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009813 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009814 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009815
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009816 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9817 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9818 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9819 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9820 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9821 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009823 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9824 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9825 unobvious parameters.
9826
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009827 Example :
9828 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9829 backend public_www
9830 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009831 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009832 stats hide-version
9833 stats scope .
9834 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009835 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009836 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9837 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009838
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009839 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9840 backend private_monitoring
9841 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009842 stats uri /admin?stats
9843 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009844
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009845 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009846
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009847
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009848stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9849 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9850 Access control for statistics
9851
9852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9853 no | no | yes | yes
9854
9855 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9856 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9857 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9858 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9859 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9860 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9861
9862 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9863 instance.
9864
9865 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9866 about ACL usage.
9867
9868
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009869stats realm <realm>
9870 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009872 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009873 Arguments :
9874 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9875 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9876 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9877
9878 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9879 using a backslash ('\').
9880
9881 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9882 only related to authentication.
9883
9884 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9885 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9886 unobvious parameters.
9887
9888 Example :
9889 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9890 backend public_www
9891 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9892 stats enable
9893 stats hide-version
9894 stats scope .
9895 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009896 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009897 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9898 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9899
9900 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9901 backend private_monitoring
9902 stats enable
9903 stats uri /admin?stats
9904 stats refresh 5s
9905
9906 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9907
9908
9909stats refresh <delay>
9910 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009912 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009913 Arguments :
9914 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9915 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9916 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9917 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9918 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9919 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9920
9921 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9922 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9923 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009924 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009925
9926 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9927 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9928 unobvious parameters.
9929
9930 Example :
9931 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9932 backend public_www
9933 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9934 stats enable
9935 stats hide-version
9936 stats scope .
9937 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009938 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009939 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9940 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9941
9942 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9943 backend private_monitoring
9944 stats enable
9945 stats uri /admin?stats
9946 stats refresh 5s
9947
9948 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9949
9950
9951stats scope { <name> | "." }
9952 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009954 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009955 Arguments :
9956 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9957 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9958 section in which the statement appears.
9959
9960 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9961 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9962 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9963 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9964 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9965 exists.
9966
9967 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9968 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9969 unobvious parameters.
9970
9971 Example :
9972 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9973 backend public_www
9974 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9975 stats enable
9976 stats hide-version
9977 stats scope .
9978 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009979 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009980 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9981 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9982
9983 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9984 backend private_monitoring
9985 stats enable
9986 stats uri /admin?stats
9987 stats refresh 5s
9988
9989 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9990
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009991
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009992stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009993 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009995 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009996
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009997 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009998 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9999
10000 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10001 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10002
10003 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10004 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010005 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010006
10007 Example :
10008 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10009 backend private_monitoring
10010 stats enable
10011 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10012 stats uri /admin?stats
10013 stats refresh 5s
10014
10015 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10016 global section.
10017
10018
10019stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010020 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10022 yes | yes | yes | yes
10023 Arguments : none
10024
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010025 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010026 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10027 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10028 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10029 - IP (socket, server)
10030 - cookie (backend, server)
10031
10032 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10033 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010034 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010035
10036 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10037
10038
10039stats show-node [ <name> ]
10040 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010042 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010043 Arguments:
10044 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10045 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10046
10047 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10048 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010049 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010050
10051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10053 unobvious parameters.
10054
10055 Example:
10056 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10057 backend private_monitoring
10058 stats enable
10059 stats show-node Europe-1
10060 stats uri /admin?stats
10061 stats refresh 5s
10062
10063 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10064 section.
10065
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010066
10067stats uri <prefix>
10068 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010070 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010071 Arguments :
10072 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10073 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10074 query string.
10075
10076 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10077 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10078 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10079 possible to reach it in the application.
10080
10081 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010082 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010083 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10084 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10085 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10086 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10087
10088 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10089 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10090 an address or a port to statistics only.
10091
10092 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10093 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10094 unobvious parameters.
10095
10096 Example :
10097 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10098 backend public_www
10099 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10100 stats enable
10101 stats hide-version
10102 stats scope .
10103 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010104 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010105 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10106 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10107
10108 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10109 backend private_monitoring
10110 stats enable
10111 stats uri /admin?stats
10112 stats refresh 5s
10113
10114 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10115
10116
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010117stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10118 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010120 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010121
10122 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010123 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010124 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010125 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010126 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10127
10128 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10129 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10130 the "stick-table" statement.
10131
10132 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10133 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10134 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10135 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10136 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10137
10138 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10139 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10140 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10141 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10142 transformation rules.
10143
10144 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10145 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10146 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10147 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10148 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10149 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10150 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10151
10152 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10153 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10154 ACL based conditions.
10155
10156 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10157 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10158 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10159 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10160
10161 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10162 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10163 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10164 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10165
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010166 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10167 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010168 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010169
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010170 Example :
10171 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10172 # last 30 minutes
10173 backend pop
10174 mode tcp
10175 balance roundrobin
10176 stick store-request src
10177 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10178 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10179 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10180
10181 backend smtp
10182 mode tcp
10183 balance roundrobin
10184 stick match src table pop
10185 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10186 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10187
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010188 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010189 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010190
10191
10192stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10193 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10195 no | no | yes | yes
10196
10197 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10198 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10199 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10200 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10201
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010202 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10203 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010204 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010205
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010206 Examples :
10207 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010208 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010209
10210 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10211 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10212 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10213
10214
10215 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10216 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10217 backend http
10218 mode http
10219 balance roundrobin
10220 stick on src table https
10221 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10222 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10223 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10224
10225 backend https
10226 mode tcp
10227 balance roundrobin
10228 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10229 stick on src
10230 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10231 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10232
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010233 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010234
10235
10236stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10237 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10239 no | no | yes | yes
10240
10241 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010242 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010243 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010244 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010245 server is selected.
10246
10247 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10248 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10249 the "stick-table" statement.
10250
10251 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10252 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10253 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10254 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10255 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10256 address.
10257
10258 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10259 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10260 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10261 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10262 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10263 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10264 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10265 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10266 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10267 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10268
10269 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10270 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10271 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10272 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10273 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10274 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10275 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10276
10277 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10278 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10279 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10280 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10281
10282 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10283 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10284 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10285 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10286 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10287 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010288 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10289 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10290 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10291 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10292 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10293 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010294
10295 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10296 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10297 the request.
10298
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010299 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10300 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010301 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010302
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010303 Example :
10304 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10305 # last 30 minutes
10306 backend pop
10307 mode tcp
10308 balance roundrobin
10309 stick store-request src
10310 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10311 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10312 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10313
10314 backend smtp
10315 mode tcp
10316 balance roundrobin
10317 stick match src table pop
10318 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10319 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10320
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010321 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010322 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010323
10324
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010325stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010326 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10327 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010328 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010330 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010331
10332 Arguments :
10333 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10334 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10335 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10336 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10337
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010338 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10339 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10340 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10341 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10342
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010343 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10344 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10345 instance.
10346
10347 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10348 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10349 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10350 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10351 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10352 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010353 to 32 characters.
10354
10355 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10356 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10357 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010358 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010359 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10360 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010361
10362 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010363 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10364 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010365 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10366 increase.
10367
10368 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010369 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10370 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10371 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010372
10373 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10374 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10375 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10376 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010377 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010378 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10379 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10380 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10381 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10382 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10383 parameter (see below).
10384
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010385 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10386 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10387 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10388 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10389 soft restart.
10390
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010391 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10392 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010393
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010394 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10395 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10396 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10397 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010398 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010399 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010400 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10401 if not expiration delay is specified.
10402
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010403 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10404 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10405 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10406 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010407 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10408 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10409 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10410 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10411 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10412 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10413 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10414 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10415 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10416 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10417 types and their arguments.
10418
10419 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10420 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10421 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10422 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10423
10424 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10425 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10426 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010427 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010428
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010429 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10430 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10431 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010432 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010433 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010434 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010435
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010436 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10437 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10438 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10439 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10440
10441 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10442 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10443 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10444 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10445 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10446 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10447
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010448 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10449 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10450 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10451 they were received.
10452
10453 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10454 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10455 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10456 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10457 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10458
10459 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10460 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10461 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10462 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10463 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10464
10465 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10466 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10467 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10468
10469 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10470 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10471 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10472 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10473 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10474
10475 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10476 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10477 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10478 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10479 the client side.
10480
10481 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10482 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10483 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10484 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10485 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10486 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10487 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10488
10489 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10490 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10491 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10492 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10493 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10494 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010495 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010496
10497 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10498 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10499 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10500 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10501 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10502 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10503
10504 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010505 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010506 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10507 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10508
10509 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10510 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10511 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10512 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10513 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10514 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10515 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10516 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10517 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10518 recommended for better fairness.
10519
10520 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010521 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010522 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10523 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10524
10525 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10526 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10527 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10528 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10529 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10530 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10531 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10532 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10533 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10534 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010535
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010536 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10537 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010538 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10539 reference it.
10540
10541 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10542 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010543 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10544 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10545 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010546
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010547 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10548 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10549 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10550 something that can be ignored.
10551
10552 Example:
10553 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10554 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10555 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10556 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10557
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010558 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010559 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010560
10561
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010562stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010563 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10565 no | no | yes | yes
10566
10567 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010568 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010569 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010570 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010571 server is selected.
10572
10573 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10574 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10575 the "stick-table" statement.
10576
10577 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10578 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10579 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10580 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10581
10582 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10583 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10584 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10585 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10586 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10587 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010588 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010589 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10590 rules.
10591
10592 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10593 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10594 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10595 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10596 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10597 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10598 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10599
10600 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10601 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10602 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10603 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10604
10605 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10606 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10607 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10608 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10609 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10610 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010611 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10612 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10613 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10614 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10615 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10616 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10617 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10618 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10619 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010620
10621 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10622
10623 Example :
10624 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10625 backend https
10626 mode tcp
10627 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010628 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010629 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010630
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010631 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10632 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10633
10634 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10635 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10636 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10637
10638 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10639 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010640
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010641 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10642 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10643 # at offset 44.
10644
10645 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10646 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10647
10648 # Learn on response if server hello.
10649 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010650
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010651 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10652 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10653
10654 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10655 extraction.
10656
10657
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010658tcp-check comment <string>
10659 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10660 it fails.
10661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10662 yes | no | yes | yes
10663
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010664 Arguments :
10665 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10666 rule fails.
10667
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010668 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10669 user-friendly error reporting.
10670
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010671 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10672 "tcp-check expect".
10673
10674
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010675tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10676 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010677 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010678 Opens a new connection
10679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010680 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010681
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010682 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010683 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10684
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010685 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010686 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010687
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010688 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010689 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10690 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010691 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010692
10693 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010694
10695 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10696
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010697 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10698
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010699 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10700
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010701 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10702
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010703 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10704 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10705 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10706 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10707
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010708 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10709 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10710 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10711 haproxy -vv.
10712
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010713 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010714
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010715 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10716 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10717 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10718
10719 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10720 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10721 of the sequence.
10722
10723 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10724 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10725 do.
10726
10727 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10728 unset-var or comment rules.
10729
10730 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010731 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10732 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10733 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10734 option tcp-check
10735 tcp-check connect
10736 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10737 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10738 tcp-check send \r\n
10739 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10740 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10741 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10742 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10743 tcp-check send \r\n
10744 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10745 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10746
10747 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10748 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010749 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010750 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10751 tcp-check connect port 143
10752 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10753 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10754
10755 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10756
10757
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010758tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010759 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010760 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010761 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010762 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010763 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010764 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010765
10766 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010767 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10768
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010769 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10770 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10771 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10772 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10773 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10774 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10775 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10776 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10777 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10778 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10779
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010780 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010781 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10782 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010783 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10784 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10785 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10786
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010787 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10788 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10789 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010790 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10791 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10792 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10793 example 404 with disable-on-404
10794 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10795 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010796 By default "L7OK" is used.
10797
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010798 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10799 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010800 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10801 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10802 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10803 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10804 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10805 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010806
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010807 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010808 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010809 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10810 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10811 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10812 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010813 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10814
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010815 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10816 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10817 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10818 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10819
10820 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10821 informational message reported in logs if an error
10822 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10823 log-format string.
10824
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010825 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10826 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10827 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10828 followed by some converters.
10829
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010830 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10831 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10832 with the usual backslash ('\').
10833 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010834 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010835 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10836 used upper or lower case.
10837
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010838 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10839
10840 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10841 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10842 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10843 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10844 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10845 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10846 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10847 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10848
10849 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10850 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10851 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10852 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10853 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10854 expression.
10855
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010856 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10857 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10858 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10859 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10860 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10861 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10862
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010863 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10864 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10865 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10866 this exact hexadecimal string.
10867 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10868
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010869 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10870 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10871 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10872 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10873 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10874 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10875 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10876 size.
10877
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010878 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10879 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10880 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10881 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10882 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10883 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10884 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10885 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10886 in a binary string before matching the response's
10887 buffer.
10888
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010889 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10890 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10891 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10892 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10893 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10894 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10895 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10896 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10897 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10898 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10899 the null character.
10900
10901 Examples :
10902 # perform a POP check
10903 option tcp-check
10904 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10905
10906 # perform an IMAP check
10907 option tcp-check
10908 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10909
10910 # look for the redis master server
10911 option tcp-check
10912 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010913 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010914 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10915 tcp-check expect string role:master
10916 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10917 tcp-check expect string +OK
10918
10919
10920 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10921 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10922
10923
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010924tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10925tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10926 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10927 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010928 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010929 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010930
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010931 Arguments :
10932 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10933
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010934 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10935 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010936
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010937 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10938 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010939
10940 Examples :
10941 # look for the redis master server
10942 option tcp-check
10943 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10944 tcp-check expect string role:master
10945
10946 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10947 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10948
10949
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010950tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10951tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10952 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10953 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010956
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010957 Arguments :
10958 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010959
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010960 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10961 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010962
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010963 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10964 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10965 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010966
10967 Examples :
10968 # redis check in binary
10969 option tcp-check
10970 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10971 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10972
10973
10974 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10975 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10976
10977
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010978tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010979 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010980 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010981 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010982
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010983 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010984 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10985 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10986 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10987 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10988 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10989 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10990 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10991 and '-'.
10992
10993 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10994
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010995 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010996 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10997
10998
10999tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011000 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011002 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011003
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011004 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011005 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11006 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11007 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11008 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11009 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11010 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11011 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11012 and '-'.
11013
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011014 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011015 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11016
11017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011018tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11019 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11021 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011022 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011023 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11024 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011025
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011026 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011027
11028 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11029 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011030 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11031 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11032 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11033 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11034 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11035 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011037 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11038 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11039 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11040 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011041
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011042 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011043 - accept :
11044 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11045 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11046 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011048 - reject :
11049 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11050 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11051 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11052 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11053 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11054 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11055 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11056 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11057 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11058 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11059 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011060 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011061
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011062 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11063 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11064 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11065 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11066 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11067 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11068 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11069 hosts.
11070
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011071 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11072 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11073 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11074 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11075 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11076 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11077 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11078 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11079
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011080 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11081 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11082 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11083 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11084 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11085 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11086 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11087 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11088 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011089 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11090 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011091
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011092 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011093 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011094 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11095 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11096 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011097 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011098 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
11099 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11100 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11101 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11102 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11103 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11104 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11105 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011107 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011108 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011109 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011110 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011111 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11112 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11113 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011114
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011115 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11116 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11117 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11118 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011120 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11121 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11122 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11123 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11124 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011125 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11126 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11127 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11128 layer7 information is extracted.
11129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011130 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11131 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11132 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11133 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11134 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011135
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011136 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11137 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11138 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11139 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11140
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011141 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11142 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11143 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11144 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11145
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011146 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11147 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11148 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11149 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11150 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011151
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011152 - set-src <expr> :
11153 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11154 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11155 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011156 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011158 Arguments:
11159 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11160 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011161
11162 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011163 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11164
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011165 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11166 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011167
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011168 - set-src-port <expr> :
11169 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11170 expression.
11171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011172 Arguments:
11173 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11174 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011175
11176 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011177 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11178
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011179 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11180 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11181 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011182
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011183 - set-dst <expr> :
11184 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11185 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11186 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11187 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11188 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11189
11190 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11191 followed by some converters.
11192
11193 Example:
11194
11195 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11196 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11197
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011198 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11199 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11200
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011201 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11202 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11203 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11204 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11205
11206
11207 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11208 followed by some converters.
11209
11210 Example:
11211
11212 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11213
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011214 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11215 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11216 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11217
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011218 - "silent-drop" :
11219 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011220 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011221 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11222 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11223 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11224 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11225 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011226 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11227 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011228 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11229 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011230 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011231 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11232 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11233 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11234 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011236 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11237 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11238 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011240 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11241 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11242 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011244 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011245 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011246 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011248 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11249 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11250 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011252 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011253 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11254 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011255
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011256 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11257
11258 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11259
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011260 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11261
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011262 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011263
11264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011265tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11266 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011268 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011269 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011270 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11271 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011273 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011275 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011276 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11277 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11278 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11279 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011280
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011281 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11282 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11283 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11284 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011285 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11286 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11287 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11288 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11289 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11290 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011291 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011292 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011294 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11295 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11296 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11297 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011298
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011299 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011300 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011301 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011302 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11303 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011304 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011305 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011306 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011307 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011308 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011309 - set-dst <expr>
11310 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011311 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011312 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011313 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011314 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011315 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011317 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11318 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011319 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11320 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011321
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011322 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11323 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11324 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11325 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11326 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11327 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011329 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011330 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11331 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011332
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011333 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11334 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11335 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11336 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11337 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11338 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11339
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011340 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011341 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11342 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11343 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11344 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11345 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11346 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11347 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11348 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11349 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11350 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011351
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011352 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011353 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11354 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11355 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011356
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011357 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11358 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11359
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011360 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011361 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11362 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011363
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011364 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11365 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011366 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011367 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11368 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011369 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011371 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011372 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11373 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011374 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011375 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11376 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011377
11378 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11379 followed by some converters.
11380
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011381 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11382 <var-name>.
11383
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011384 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11385 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11386 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11387 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11388 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11389
11390 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11391 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11392 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11393 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11394 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11395 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11396 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11397 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11398 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11399 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11400 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11401
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011402 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11403 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11404 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11405 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11406 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11407
11408 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11409
11410 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11411
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011412 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11413 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11414 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11415 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11416 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11417 evaluated.
11418
11419 Example:
11420 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11421
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011422 Example:
11423
11424 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011425 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011426
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011427 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011428 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11429 # and reject everything else.
11430 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11431 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011432 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011433 tcp-request content reject
11434
11435 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011436 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11437 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11438 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011439 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011440
11441 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11442 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11443 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011444 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011445 tcp-request content reject
11446
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011447 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011448 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011449 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011450 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011451 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11452 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011453
11454 Example:
11455 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11456 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011457 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011459 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011460 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011461
11462 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011463 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011464 # protecting all our sites
11465 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011466 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11467 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011468 ...
11469 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11470
11471 backend http_dynamic
11472 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011473 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011474 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011475 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011476 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011477 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011478 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011480 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011481
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011482 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11483 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011484
11485
11486tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11487 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011489 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011490 Arguments :
11491 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11492 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11493 as explained at the top of this document.
11494
11495 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11496 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11497 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11498 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11499 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11500
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011501 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11502 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11503 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11504 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11505
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011506 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11507 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011508 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011509 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011510 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11511 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11512 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11513 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011514
11515 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11516 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11517 it pass through unaffected.
11518
11519 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11520 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11521 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011522 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011523 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11524 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011525 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11526 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11527 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011528
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011529 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011530 "timeout client".
11531
11532
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011533tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11534 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11536 no | no | yes | yes
11537 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011538 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11539 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011540
11541 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11542
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011543 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011544 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11545 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011546 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11547 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011548
11549 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11550
11551 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11552 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11553 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11554 inserted.
11555
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011556 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011557 - accept :
11558 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11559 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11560 the rules evaluation.
11561
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011562 - close :
11563 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11564 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11565 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11566 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11567 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11568 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011569 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011570 protocols.
11571
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011572 - reject :
11573 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11574 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011575 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011576
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011577 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11578 Sets a variable.
11579
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011580 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11581 Unsets a variable.
11582
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011583 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11584 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11585 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11586 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11587
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011588 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11589 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11590 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11591 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11592
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011593 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11594 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11595 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11596 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11597 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011598
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011599 - "silent-drop" :
11600 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011601 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011602 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11603 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11604 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11605 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11606 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011607 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11608 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011609 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11610 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011611 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011612 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11613 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11614 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11615 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11616
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011617 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11618 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11619
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011620 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11621 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11622 for changing the default action to a reject.
11623
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011624 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11625 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11626 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11627 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011628 period.
11629
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011630 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11631 declared inline.
11632
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011633 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11634 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011635 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011636 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11637 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011638 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011639 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011640 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011641 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11642 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011643 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011644 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11645 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011646
11647 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11648 followed by some converters.
11649
11650 Example:
11651
11652 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11653
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011654 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11655 <var-name>.
11656
11657 Example:
11658
11659 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11660
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011661 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11662 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11663 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11664 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11665 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11666
11667 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11668
11669 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11670
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011671 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11672
11673 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11674
11675
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011676tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11677 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11679 no | yes | yes | no
11680 Arguments :
11681 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11682 below.
11683
11684 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11685
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011686 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011687 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11688 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11689 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11690 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11691 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11692 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11693 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011694 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011695 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11696 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11697 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11698 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11699 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11700 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11701 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11702 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11703 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11704 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11705 instead.
11706
11707 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11708 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11709 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11710 rules which may be inserted.
11711
11712 Several types of actions are supported :
11713 - accept : the request is accepted
11714 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11715 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11716 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011717 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011718 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011719 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011720 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011721 - silent-drop
11722
11723 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11724 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11725 sections for a complete description.
11726
11727 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11728 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11729 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11730
11731 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11732 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11733 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11734 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11735 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11736
11737 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11738 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11739
11740 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11741 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11742 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11743
11744 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11745 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11746 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11747
11748 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11749 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11750 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11751
11752 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11753 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11754 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11755
11756 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11757
11758 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11759
11760
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011761tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11762 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11764 no | no | yes | yes
11765 Arguments :
11766 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11767 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11768 as explained at the top of this document.
11769
11770 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11771
11772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011773timeout check <timeout>
11774 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11775 established.
11776
11777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11778 yes | no | yes | yes
11779 Arguments:
11780 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11781 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11782 as explained at the top of this document.
11783
11784 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11785 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011786 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011787 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011788 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11789 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11790 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011791
11792 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11793 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11794
11795 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11796 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011797 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011798
11799 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11800 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11801 forget about it.
11802
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011803 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11804 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011805
11806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011807timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011808 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11810 yes | yes | yes | no
11811 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011812 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011813 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11814 as explained at the top of this document.
11815
11816 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11817 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11818 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011819 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11820 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11821 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11822 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011823 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11824 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11825 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011826 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011827 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011828 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11829 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011830 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11831 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011832
11833 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11834 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11835 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11836 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011837 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011838 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11839
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011840 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011841
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011842 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011844
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011845timeout client-fin <timeout>
11846 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11848 yes | yes | yes | no
11849 Arguments :
11850 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11851 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11852 as explained at the top of this document.
11853
11854 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11855 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11856 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11857 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11858 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11859 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11860 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011861 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11862 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11863 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011864
11865 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11866 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11867 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11868
11869 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11870
11871
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011872timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011873 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11875 yes | no | yes | yes
11876 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011877 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011878 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11879 as explained at the top of this document.
11880
11881 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011882 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011883 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011884 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011885 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11886 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011887
11888 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11889 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11890 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11891 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011892 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011893 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11894
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011895 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011897
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011898timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11899 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11901 yes | yes | yes | yes
11902 Arguments :
11903 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11904 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11905 as explained at the top of this document.
11906
11907 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11908 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11909 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11910 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11911 once the request has started to present itself.
11912
11913 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11914 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11915 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11916 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11917 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11918
11919 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11920 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11921 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11922 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11923
11924 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11925 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011926 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011927 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11928 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011929 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011930
11931 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11932 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11933 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11934 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11935
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011936 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11937 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011938 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11939
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011940 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11941
11942
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011943timeout http-request <timeout>
11944 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011946 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011947 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011948 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011949 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11950 as explained at the top of this document.
11951
11952 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11953 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11954 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11955 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11956 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11957 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11958 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011959 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11960 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11961 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11962 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011963 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011964 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11965 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011966
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011967 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11968 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11969 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11970 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11971 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011972 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011973
11974 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11975 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011976 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011977 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11978 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11979
11980 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011981 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11982 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11983 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011984
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011985 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011986 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011987
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011988
11989timeout queue <timeout>
11990 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11992 yes | no | yes | yes
11993 Arguments :
11994 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11995 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11996 as explained at the top of this document.
11997
11998 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11999 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12000 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12001 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12002 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12003
12004 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12005 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12006 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12007 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12008
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012009 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012010
12011
12012timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012013 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12015 yes | no | yes | yes
12016 Arguments :
12017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12019 as explained at the top of this document.
12020
12021 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12022 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12023 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12024 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12025 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12026 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12027 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12028
12029 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12030 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12031 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12032 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12033 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012034 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012035 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012036 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12037 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012038 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12039 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012040
12041 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12042 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12043 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12044 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012045 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012046 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12047
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012048 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012049
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012050
12051timeout server-fin <timeout>
12052 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12054 yes | no | yes | yes
12055 Arguments :
12056 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12057 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12058 as explained at the top of this document.
12059
12060 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12061 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12062 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12063 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12064 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12065 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12066 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12067 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12068 situations, it should not be needed.
12069
12070 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12071 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12072 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12073
12074 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12075
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012076
12077timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012078 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12080 yes | yes | yes | yes
12081 Arguments :
12082 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12083 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12084 as explained at the top of this document.
12085
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012086 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12087 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12088 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012089
12090 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12091 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12092 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12093 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012094 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012095
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012096 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012097
12098
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012099timeout tunnel <timeout>
12100 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12102 yes | no | yes | yes
12103 Arguments :
12104 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12105 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12106 as explained at the top of this document.
12107
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012108 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012109 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12110 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12111 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012112 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12113 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012114 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12115 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12116 specified.
12117
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012118 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12119 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12120 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12121 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12122 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12123 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12124 state.
12125
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012126 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12127 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12128 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12129 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012130 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012131
12132 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12133 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12134 forget about it.
12135
12136 Example :
12137 defaults http
12138 option http-server-close
12139 timeout connect 5s
12140 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012141 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012142 timeout server 30s
12143 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12144
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012145 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012146
12147
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012148transparent (deprecated)
12149 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012151 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012152 Arguments : none
12153
12154 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12155 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12156 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12157 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12158 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12159 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12160 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12161 appropriate server.
12162
12163 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12164
12165 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12166 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12167
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012168 See also: "option transparent"
12169
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012170unique-id-format <string>
12171 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12173 yes | yes | yes | no
12174 Arguments :
12175 <string> is a log-format string.
12176
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012177 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12178 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12179 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12180 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012181
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012182 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12183 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12184 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12185 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12186 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12187 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12188 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12189 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012190
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012191 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12192 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012193
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012194 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012195
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012196 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012197
12198 will generate:
12199
12200 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12201
12202 See also: "unique-id-header"
12203
12204unique-id-header <name>
12205 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12207 yes | yes | yes | no
12208 Arguments :
12209 <name> is the name of the header.
12210
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012211 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12212 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012213
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012214 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012215
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012216 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012217 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12218
12219 will generate:
12220
12221 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12222
12223 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012224
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012225use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012226 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12228 no | yes | yes | no
12229 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012230 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12231 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012232
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012233 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12234 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012235
12236 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12237 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12238 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012239 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012240 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012241 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12242 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012243
12244 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12245 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12246 assign the backend.
12247
12248 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12249 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12250 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12251 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12252 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12253 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12254
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012255 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012256 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012257 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12258 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12259 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12260
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012261 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12262 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12263 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12264 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12265 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12266 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12267 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12268 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12269 cannot be forced from the request.
12270
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012271 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012272 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12273 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12274
12275 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12276 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012277
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012278use-fcgi-app <name>
12279 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12281 no | no | yes | yes
12282 Arguments :
12283 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12284
12285 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012286
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012287use-server <server> if <condition>
12288use-server <server> unless <condition>
12289 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12291 no | no | yes | yes
12292 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012293 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12294 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012295
12296 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12297
12298 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12299 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12300 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12301
12302 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12303 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12304 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12305 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12306 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12307 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12308 matches will assign the server.
12309
12310 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12311 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12312 with the next rules until one matches.
12313
12314 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12315 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12316 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12317 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12318
12319 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12320 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12321 stripped.
12322
12323 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12324 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012325 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12326 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12327 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012328
12329 Example :
12330 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12331 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12332 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12333 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012334 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012335 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012336 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012337 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12338 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12339
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012340 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12341 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12342 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12343 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012344 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012345 and we fall back to load balancing.
12346
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012347 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012348
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012349
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100123505. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012351--------------------------
12352
12353The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12354depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12355settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12356written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12357described in this section.
12358
12359
123605.1. Bind options
12361-----------------
12362
12363The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12364as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12365no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12366parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12367while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12368provided immediately after the setting name.
12369
12370The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12371
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012372accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12373 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12374 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12375 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12376 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12377 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12378 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12379 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12380 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12381 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012382 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12383 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12384 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012385
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012386accept-proxy
12387 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012388 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12389 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012390 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12391 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12392 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12393 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012394 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012395 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12396 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012397 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12398 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012399
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012400allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012401 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012402 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012403 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012404 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12405 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012406
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012407alpn <protocols>
12408 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12409 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12410 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012411 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012412 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012413 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12414 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12415 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12416 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12417 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12418 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12419 preference, like below :
12420
12421 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012422
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012423backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012424 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012425 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12426
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012427curves <curves>
12428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12429 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12430 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12431 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12432 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12433 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12434
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012435ecdhe <named curve>
12436 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012437 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12438 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012439
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012440ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12442 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12443 client's certificate.
12444
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012445ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12447 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12448 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12449 error is ignored.
12450
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012451ca-sign-file <cafile>
12452 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12453 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12454 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12455 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12456 'generate-certificates' for details.
12457
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012458ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012459 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12460 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12461 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12462 'generate-certificates' for details.
12463
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012464ca-verify-file <cafile>
12465 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12466 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12467 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12468 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12469 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12470
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012471ciphers <ciphers>
12472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12473 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012474 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012475 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012476 information and recommendations see e.g.
12477 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12478 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12479 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12480
12481ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12483 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12484 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12485 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012486 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12487 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012488
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012489crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012490 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12491 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12492 to verify client's certificate.
12493
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012494crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012495 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12496 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12497 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12498 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12499 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012500 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12501 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012502
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012503 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12504 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12505
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012506 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12507 are loaded.
12508
12509 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012510 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12511 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12512 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12513 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12514 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12515 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12516 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012517 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012518
12519 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12520 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12521 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12522 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012523 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12524 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012525
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012526 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012527
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012528 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012529 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012530 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12531 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012532 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12533 clients).
12534
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012535 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12536 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12537 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12538 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12539 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12540 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12541 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12542 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12543 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12544 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12545 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12546 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12547 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12548
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012549 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12550 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12551 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12552 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12553 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12554
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012555 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12556 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12557 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12558 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012559
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012560 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12561 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12562 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012563
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012564crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012565 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012566 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012567 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012568 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012569
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012570crt-list <file>
12571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012572 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12573 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012574
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012575 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12576
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012577 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12578 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12579 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12580 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12581 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012582
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012583 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12584 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12585 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12586 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12587 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12588 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12589 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12590 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012591
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012592 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12593 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12594 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012595
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012596 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12597
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012598 crt-list file example:
12599 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012600 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012601 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012602 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012603 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012604
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012605defer-accept
12606 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12607 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12608 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012609 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012610 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12611 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12612 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12613 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12614 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12615 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12616 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12617
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012618expose-fd listeners
12619 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12620 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012621 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12622 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012623 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012624
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012625force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012626 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012627 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012628 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012629 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012630
12631force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012632 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012633 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012634 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012635
12636force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012637 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012638 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012639 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012640
12641force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012642 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012643 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012644 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012645
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012646force-tlsv13
12647 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12648 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012649 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012650
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012651generate-certificates
12652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12653 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12654 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12655 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12656 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12657 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12658 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12659 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12660 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12661 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12662 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12663
12664 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12665 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012666 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012667 certificate is used many times.
12668
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012669gid <gid>
12670 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12671 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12672 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12673 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12674 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12675
12676group <group>
12677 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12678 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12679 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12680 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12681 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12682
12683id <id>
12684 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12685 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12686 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12687 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12688
12689interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012690 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12691 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12692 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12693 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12694 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12695 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012696 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12697 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12698 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12699 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12700 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12701 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012702
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012703level <level>
12704 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12705 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12706 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012707 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012708 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12709 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12710 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012711 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012712 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012713 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012714 all counters).
12715
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012716severity-output <format>
12717 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12718 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12719 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12720 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12721 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12722 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12723 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12724 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12725 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12726 rfc5424 convention.
12727
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012728maxconn <maxconn>
12729 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12730 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12731 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12732 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12733 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12734 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12735 eat all memory.
12736
12737mode <mode>
12738 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12739 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12740 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12741 UNIX sockets.
12742
12743mss <maxseg>
12744 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12745 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12746 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12747 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12748 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12749 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12750 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12751 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12752 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12753 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12754 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12755
12756name <name>
12757 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12758 page.
12759
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012760namespace <name>
12761 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12762 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12763 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12764 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12765
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012766nice <nice>
12767 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12768 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12769 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12770 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12771 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12772 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12773 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12774 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12775 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12776 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12777 one for an RDP socket.
12778
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012779no-ca-names
12780 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12781 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012782 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012783
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012784no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012786 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012787 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012788 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012789 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12790 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012791
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012792no-tls-tickets
12793 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12794 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12795 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012796 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12797 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012798 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12799 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12800 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012801
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012802no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012804 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012805 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012806 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012807 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12808 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012809
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012810no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012811 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012812 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012813 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012814 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012815 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12816 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012817
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012818no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012820 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012821 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012822 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012823 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12824 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012825
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012826no-tlsv13
12827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12828 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12829 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12830 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012831 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12832 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012833
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012834npn <protocols>
12835 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12836 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12837 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012838 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012839 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012840 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12841 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12842 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12843 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12844 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012845
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012846prefer-client-ciphers
12847 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12848 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12849 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012850 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12851 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12852 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012853
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012854process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012855 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012856 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012857 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012858 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12859 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12860 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12861 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012862 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012863 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12864 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12865 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12866 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12867 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012868
12869 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12870
12871 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12872 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12873 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12874 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12875 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12876 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12877 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12878 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012879
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012880proto <name>
12881 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12882 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12883 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12884 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012885 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012886 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012887 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012888 h2" on the bind line.
12889
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012890ssl
12891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012892 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012893 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12894 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012895 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12896 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012897
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012898ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12899 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012900 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12901 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12902 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012903 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12904
12905ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012906 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12907 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12908 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12909 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012910
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012911strict-sni
12912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12913 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12914 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12915 See the "crt" option for more information.
12916
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012917tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012918 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012919 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12920 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012921 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012922 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12923 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12924 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12925 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12926 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12927 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12928 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12929
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012930tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012931 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012932 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12933 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12934 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12935 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12936 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12937 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12938 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012939 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12940 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12941 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012942
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012943tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12944 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012945 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12946 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12947 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12948 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12949 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12950 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12951 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12952 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12953 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12954 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012955 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12956 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12957
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012958transparent
12959 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12960 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12961 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12962 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12963 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12964 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12965 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12966 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12967 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12968 so check for support with your vendor.
12969
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012970v4v6
12971 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12972 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12973 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12974 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012975 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012976
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012977v6only
12978 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12979 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12980 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012981 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12982 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012983
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012984uid <uid>
12985 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12986 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12987 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12988 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12989 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12990
12991user <user>
12992 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12993 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12994 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12995 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12996 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12997
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012998verify [none|optional|required]
12999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13000 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13001 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13002 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13003 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013004 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13005 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13006 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13007 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013008
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200130095.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013010------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013012The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13013which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13014arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13015settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13016after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13017Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13018address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013019
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013020 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013021 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013022
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013023Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13024keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013026The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013027
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013028addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013029 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013030 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13031 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13032 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13033 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13034 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013035
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013036agent-check
13037 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013038 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013039 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13040 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13041 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013042
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013043 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013044 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013045 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13046 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13047 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013048
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013049 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13050 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13051 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13052 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13053 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013054
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013055 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013056 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013057
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013058 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13059 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13060 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013061
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013062 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13063 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13064 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013065
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013066 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013067 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13068 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13069 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13070 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013071 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013072 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013073
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013074 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13075 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013076
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013077 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13078 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13079 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13080 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13081 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13082 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13083 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13084 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13085 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013086
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013087 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13088 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013089 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13090 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13091 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013092 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013093
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013094 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013095 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013096
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013097agent-send <string>
13098 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13099 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13100 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13101 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13102 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13103
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013104agent-inter <delay>
13105 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13106 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13107
13108 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13109 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13110 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13111 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13112 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13113 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13114 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13115 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13116 of backends use the same servers.
13117
13118 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13119
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013120agent-addr <addr>
13121 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13122
13123 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13124 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13125 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13126 hostname, it will be resolved.
13127
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013128agent-port <port>
13129 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13130
13131 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13132
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013133allow-0rtt
13134 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013135 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13136 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013137
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013138alpn <protocols>
13139 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13140 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13141 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013142 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013143 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13144 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13145 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13146 now obsolete NPN extension.
13147 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13148 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13149
13150 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013152backup
13153 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13154 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13155 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13156 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013157 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13158 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013159
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013160ca-file <cafile>
13161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13162 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13163 server's certificate.
13164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013165check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013166 This option enables health checks on a server:
13167 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13168 considered available.
13169 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13170 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13171 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13172 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13173 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13174 set.
13175 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13176 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13177 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13178 exchanges succeed.
13179
13180 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13181 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13182 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13183 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13184 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013185 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013186 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13187
13188 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13189 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13190
13191 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13192 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13193
13194 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13195 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13196 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13197 available.
13198
13199 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13200 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13201 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13202
13203 Example:
13204 # simple tcp check
13205 backend foo
13206 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13207 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13208 backend foo
13209 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13210 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13211 backend foo
13212 option tcp-check
13213 tcp-check connect
13214 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013215
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013216check-send-proxy
13217 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13218 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13219 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13220 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13221 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13222 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13223 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13224
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013225check-alpn <protocols>
13226 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13227 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13228 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13229
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013230check-proto <name>
13231 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13232 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13233 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13234 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013235 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013236 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13237 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13238
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013239check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013240 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013241 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13242 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013243
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013244check-ssl
13245 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13246 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13247 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13248 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013249 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013250 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13251 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013252 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013253 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13254 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013255
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013256check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013257 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013258 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13259 for normal traffic.
13260
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013261ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013262 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13263 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13264 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013265 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13266 information and recommendations see e.g.
13267 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13268 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13269 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013270
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013271ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13273 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13274 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13275 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013276 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13277 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13278 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013280cookie <value>
13281 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13282 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13283 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13284 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13285 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13286 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13287 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13288
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013289crl-file <crlfile>
13290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13291 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13292 to verify server's certificate.
13293
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013294crt <cert>
13295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13296 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13297 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13298 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13299 certificate request.
13300
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013301disabled
13302 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13303 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13304 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13305 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13306 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013307 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013308
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013309enabled
13310 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13311 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13312 default value.
13313 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13314 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013316error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013317 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13318 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13319 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013321 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013322
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013323fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013324 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13325 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13326 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13327
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013328force-sslv3
13329 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13330 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013331 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013332 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013333
13334force-tlsv10
13335 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013336 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013337 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013338
13339force-tlsv11
13340 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013341 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013342 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013343
13344force-tlsv12
13345 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013346 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013347 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013348
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013349force-tlsv13
13350 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13351 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013352 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013354id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013355 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13356 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13357 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013358
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013359init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13360 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13361 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013362 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013363 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13364 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13365 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13366 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13367 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13368 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13369 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13370 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13371 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013372 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013373 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13374 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13375 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13376 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13377 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13378 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013379 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013380
13381 Example:
13382 defaults
13383 # never fail on address resolution
13384 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013386inter <delay>
13387fastinter <delay>
13388downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013389 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13390 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13391 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13392 between checks depending on the server state :
13393
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013394 Server state | Interval used
13395 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13396 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13397 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13398 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13399 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13400 or yet unchecked. |
13401 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13402 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13403 | "inter" otherwise.
13404 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013406 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13407 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13408 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13409 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013410 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13411 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13412 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13413 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13414 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013415
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013416log-proto <logproto>
13417 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13418 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13419 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13420 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013422maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013423 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13424 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013425 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13426 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013427 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13428 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13429 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13430 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13431
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013432 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13433 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13434 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13435 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13436 than 50 concurrent requests.
13437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013438maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013439 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13440 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13441 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13442 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13443 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13444 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13445 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13446
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013447max-reuse <count>
13448 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13449 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13450 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13451 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13452 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13453 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13454 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13455 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13456
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013457minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013458 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13459 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13460 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13461 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13462 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13463 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013464 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013465 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013466
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013467namespace <name>
13468 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13469 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13470 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13471 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13472
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013473no-agent-check
13474 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13475 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13476 default value.
13477 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13478 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13479
13480no-backup
13481 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13482 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13483 default value.
13484 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13485 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13486
13487no-check
13488 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13489 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13490 default value.
13491 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13492 "default-server" "check" setting.
13493
13494no-check-ssl
13495 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13496 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13497 default value.
13498 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13499 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13500
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013501no-send-proxy
13502 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13503 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13504 default value.
13505 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13506 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13507
13508no-send-proxy-v2
13509 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13510 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13511 default value.
13512 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13513 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13514
13515no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13516 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13517 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13518 default value.
13519 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13520 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13521
13522no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13523 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13524 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13525 default value.
13526 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13527 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13528
13529no-ssl
13530 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13531 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13532 default value.
13533 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13534 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13535
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013536no-ssl-reuse
13537 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13538 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13539 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13540 and for paranoid users.
13541
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013542no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013543 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13544 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013545 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013546
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013547 Supported in default-server: No
13548
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013549no-tls-tickets
13550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13551 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13552 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013553 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13554 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013555 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13556 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13557 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013558 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013559
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013560no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013561 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013562 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13563 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013564 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13565 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013566 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013567
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013568 Supported in default-server: No
13569
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013570no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013571 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013572 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13573 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013574 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13575 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013576 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013577
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013578 Supported in default-server: No
13579
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013580no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013581 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013582 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13583 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013584 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13585 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013586 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013587
13588 Supported in default-server: No
13589
13590no-tlsv13
13591 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13592 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13593 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13594 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13595 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013596 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013597
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013598 Supported in default-server: No
13599
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013600no-verifyhost
13601 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13602 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13603 default value.
13604 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13605 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013606
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013607no-tfo
13608 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13609 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13610 default value.
13611 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13612 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13613
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013614non-stick
13615 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13616 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13617 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13618
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013619npn <protocols>
13620 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13621 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13622 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013623 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013624 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13625 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13626 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013628observe <mode>
13629 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13630 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13631 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13632 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13633 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13634 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013635 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013636
13637 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013639on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013640 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13641 Currently, four modes are available:
13642 - fastinter: force fastinter
13643 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13644 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13645 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13646 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13647
13648 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13649
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013650on-marked-down <action>
13651 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13652 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013653 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13654 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13655 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13656 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13657 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13658 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13659 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13660 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013661
13662 Actions are disabled by default
13663
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013664on-marked-up <action>
13665 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13666 Currently one action is available:
13667 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13668 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13669 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13670 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013671 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13672 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013673 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13674 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13675
13676 Actions are disabled by default
13677
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013678pool-low-conn <max>
13679 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13680 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13681 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13682 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13683 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13684 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13685 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13686 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13687 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13688 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13689 applying to "http-reuse".
13690
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013691pool-max-conn <max>
13692 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13693 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13694 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13695 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13696 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13697 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13698
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013699pool-purge-delay <delay>
13700 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013701 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013702 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013704port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013705 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13706 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13707 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13708 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13709 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13710 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13711
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013712proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013713 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13714 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13715 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13716 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013717 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013718 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013720redir <prefix>
13721 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13722 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13723 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13724 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13725 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13726 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13727 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13728 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013729 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013730 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013731 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13732 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13733 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13734 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13735
13736 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013738rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013739 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13740 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13741 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13742
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013743resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13744 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13745 server.
13746
13747 Available options:
13748
13749 * allow-dup-ip
13750 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13751 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13752 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13753 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13754 For such case, simply enable this option.
13755 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13756
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013757 * ignore-weight
13758 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13759 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13760 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13761
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013762 * prevent-dup-ip
13763 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13764 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13765 same fqdn.
13766 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13767
13768 Example:
13769 backend b_myapp
13770 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13771 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13772 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13773
13774 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13775 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13776 it
13777 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13778 different address
13779
13780 Default value: not set
13781
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013782resolve-prefer <family>
13783 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13784 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13785 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13786 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13787
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013788 Default value: ipv6
13789
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013790 Example:
13791
13792 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013793
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013794resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013795 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013796 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013797 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013798 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13799 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013800 configured network, another address is selected.
13801
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013802 Example:
13803
13804 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013805
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013806resolvers <id>
13807 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13808 hostname.
13809
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013810 Example:
13811
13812 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013813
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013814 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013815
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013816send-proxy
13817 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13818 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13819 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13820 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013821 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13822 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13823 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13824 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13825 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13826 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13827 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13828 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13829 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13830 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013831 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13832 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013833
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013834send-proxy-v2
13835 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13836 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13837 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13838 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013839 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13840 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13841 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13842 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013843
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013844proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013845 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13846 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13847
13848 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13849 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13850 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13851 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13852 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13853 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13854 connection is supported).
13855 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13856 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13857 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13858 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13859 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13860 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13861 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013862
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013863send-proxy-v2-ssl
13864 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13865 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13866 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13867 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13868 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13869 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13870 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013871 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13872 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013873
13874send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13875 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13876 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13877 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13878 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13879 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13880 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13881 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13882 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013883 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13884 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013885
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013886slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013887 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13888 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13889 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13890 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13891 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13892 parameters :
13893
13894 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13895 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13896
13897 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13898 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13899 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13900 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13901
13902 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13903 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13904 seen as failed.
13905
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013906sni <expression>
13907 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13908 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13909 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13910 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013911 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13912 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013913 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013914 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13915 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013916
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013917source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013918source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013919source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013920 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13921 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13922 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13923 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13924
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013925 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13926 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13927 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13928 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13929 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13930 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13931 server.
13932
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013933 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13934 specifying the source address without port(s).
13935
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013936ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013937 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13938 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13939 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13940 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13941 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13942 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013943 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13944 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013945
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013946ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13947 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13948 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13949 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13950
13951ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13952 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13953 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13954 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13955
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013956ssl-reuse
13957 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13958 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13959 default value.
13960 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13961 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13962
13963stick
13964 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13965 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13966 default value.
13967 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13968 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013969
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013970socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013971 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013972 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13973 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13974
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013975tcp-ut <delay>
13976 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13977 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13978 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013979 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013980 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13981 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13982 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13983 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13984 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13985 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13986 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13987 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13988 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13989
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013990tfo
13991 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13992 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13993 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13994 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13995 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013996 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013998track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013999 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14000 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14001 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14002 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014003 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14004
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014005tls-tickets
14006 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14007 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14008 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014009 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14010 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14011 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014012 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014013 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014014
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014015verify [none|required]
14016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014017 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014018 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14019 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014020 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014021 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14022 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14023 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14024 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14025 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14026 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14027 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14028 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014029
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014030verifyhost <hostname>
14031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014032 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14033 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14034 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14035 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14036 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14037 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14038 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14039 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014041weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014042 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14043 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14044 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014045 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14046 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14047 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14048 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14049 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14050 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014051
14052
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140535.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14054-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014055
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014056HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14057using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14058configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014059This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14060can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14061workload.
14062This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14063resolution at run time.
14064Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14065carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14066
14067
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140685.3.1. Global overview
14069----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014070
14071As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14072different steps of the process life:
14073
14074 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14075 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14076 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14077
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014078 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14079 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014080
14081A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14082 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14083 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14084 resolution to know this new IP.
14085
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014086When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014087HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014088SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14089from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14090will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14091will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014092
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014093A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014094 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014095 first valid response.
14096
14097 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14098 servers return an error.
14099
14100
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200141015.3.2. The resolvers section
14102----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014103
14104This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014105HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14106contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014107
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014108When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14109uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14110is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14111answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14112
14113When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014114used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014115
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014116 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14117 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14118 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014119
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014120 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14121 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014122
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014123 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14124 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14125 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014126
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014127For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14128following scenarios are possible:
14129
14130 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14131 ignored
14132
14133 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14134 applied
14135
14136 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14137 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14138
14139 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14140 retries the query with a new type
14141
14142 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14143 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014144
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014145As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14146a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014147<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014148
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014149
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014150resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014151 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014152
14153A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14154
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014155accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014156 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014157 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014158 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14159 by RFC 6891)
14160
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014161 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14162
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014163nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14164 DNS server description:
14165 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14166 <ip> : IP address of the server
14167 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14168
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014169parse-resolv-conf
14170 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14171 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14172 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14173
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014174hold <status> <period>
14175 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14176 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014177 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014178 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014179 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14180 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14181 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14182
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014183 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014184
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014185resolve_retries <nb>
14186 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14187 giving up.
14188 Default value: 3
14189
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014190 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14191 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14192 type.
14193
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014194timeout <event> <time>
14195 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14196 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14197 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014198 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14199 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014200 Default value: 1s
14201 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014202 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014203 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014204 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14205 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14206
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014207 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014208
14209 resolvers mydns
14210 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14211 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014212 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014213 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014214 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014215 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014216 hold other 30s
14217 hold refused 30s
14218 hold nx 30s
14219 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014220 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014221 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014222
14223
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142246. Cache
14225---------
14226
14227HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14228(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14229RAM.
14230
14231The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14232this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14233
14234If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14235independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14236when we try to allocate a new one.
14237
14238The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14239
14240It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14241"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14242for more details.
14243
14244When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14245replaced by "<CACHE>".
14246
14247
142486.1. Limitation
14249----------------
14250
14251The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14252
14253- If the response is not a 200
14254- If the response contains a Vary header
14255- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14256- If the response is not cacheable
14257
14258- If the request is not a GET
14259- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14260- If the request contains an Authorization header
14261
14262
142636.2. Setup
14264-----------
14265
14266To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14267the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14268
14269
142706.2.1. Cache section
14271---------------------
14272
14273cache <name>
14274 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14275 size of cache is mandatory.
14276
14277total-max-size <megabytes>
14278 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14279 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14280
14281max-object-size <bytes>
14282 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14283 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14284 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14285
14286max-age <seconds>
14287 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14288 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14289 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14290 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14291 default.
14292
14293
142946.2.2. Proxy section
14295---------------------
14296
14297http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14298 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14299 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14300 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14301 after this one.
14302
14303http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14304 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14305 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14306 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14307 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14308
14309
14310Example:
14311
14312 backend bck1
14313 mode http
14314
14315 http-request cache-use foobar
14316 http-response cache-store foobar
14317 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14318
14319 cache foobar
14320 total-max-size 4
14321 max-age 240
14322
14323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143247. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14325----------------------------------
14326
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014327HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14329The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14330these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14331but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14332data called patterns.
14333
14334
143357.1. ACL basics
14336---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014337
14338The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14339content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14340from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14341simple :
14342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014343 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014344 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014345 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14346 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014348The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14349adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014350
14351In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014354
14355This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14356Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14357and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014358an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14359conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14360as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14361are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014362
14363ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14364'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14365which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14366
14367There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14368performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014370The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14371specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14372this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014373methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14374ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014375
14376Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14377 - boolean
14378 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14379 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14380 - string
14381 - data block
14382
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014383Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14384converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14385would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14386The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14387which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14388
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014389Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14390keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14391fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14392which are summarized in the table below :
14393
14394 +---------------------+-----------------+
14395 | Sample or converter | Default |
14396 | output type | matching method |
14397 +---------------------+-----------------+
14398 | boolean | bool |
14399 +---------------------+-----------------+
14400 | integer | int |
14401 +---------------------+-----------------+
14402 | ip | ip |
14403 +---------------------+-----------------+
14404 | string | str |
14405 +---------------------+-----------------+
14406 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14407 +---------------------+-----------------+
14408
14409Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14410matching method, see below.
14411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14413 - boolean
14414 - integer or integer range
14415 - IP address / network
14416 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14417 - regular expression
14418 - hex block
14419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014420The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14421
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014422 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14423 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014424 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014425 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014426 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014427 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014428 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014430The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14431read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14432if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14433lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14434will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14435beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14436a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14437lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14438exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14439
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014440The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14441parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14442ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14443a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14444check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14445
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014446The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14447socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14448file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14451loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14452
14453 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14454
14455In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14456the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14457case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14458as well.
14459
14460The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14461sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14462do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14463methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14464is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014465obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014466followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14467default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14468that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14469string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14470
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014471The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14472By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14473string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14474resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14475server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014476waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014477flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14478function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014480There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14481sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14482be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014483
14484 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14485 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014486 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14487 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14488 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14489 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014490
14491 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14492 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014493 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014494
14495 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014497
14498 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014499 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014500
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014501 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014502 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14503
14504 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14505 binary or string samples.
14506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014507 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14508 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014510 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14511 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14512 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014514 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14515 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014517 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14518 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14521 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014523 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14524 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014525 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014527 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14528 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14529 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014530
14531For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14532request, it is possible to do :
14533
14534 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14535
14536In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14537buffer, one would use the following acl :
14538
14539 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14540
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014541On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14542possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14543
14544 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014546All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14547criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14548method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14549to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14550criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14551the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014553If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014554the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14555For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014557 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14558 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14559 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14560 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014561
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014562
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014563The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14564types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14565combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14566brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14567default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014569 +-------------------------------------------------+
14570 | Input sample type |
14571 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014572 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014573 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14574 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14575 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014576 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014577 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014578 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014579 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014580 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014581 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014582 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014583 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014584 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014585 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014586 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014587 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014588 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014589 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014590 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014591 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014592 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014594 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014595 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014596 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014597 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14598 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14599 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014600
14601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146027.1.1. Matching booleans
14603------------------------
14604
14605In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14606Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14607When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14608that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14609
14610Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14611return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14612"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14613
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146157.1.2. Matching integers
14616------------------------
14617
14618Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14619enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14620to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14621
14622Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14623matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14624lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014625
14626For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14627unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14628representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14629
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014630As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14631two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14632instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14633ranges and operators.
14634
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014635For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014636operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14637Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14638of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014639
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014640Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014641
14642 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14643 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14644 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14645 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14646 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14647
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014648For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014649
14650 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14651
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014652This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14653
14654 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14655
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146577.1.3. Matching strings
14658-----------------------
14659
14660String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14661different forms :
14662
14663 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014664 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014665
14666 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014667 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014668
14669 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14670 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14671
14672 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14673 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14674
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014675 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014676 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14677 matches.
14678
14679 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14680 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14681 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014682
14683String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14684exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14685characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14686string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14687to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014688before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014689
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014690Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14691(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14692Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14693
14694Example:
14695 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14696 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14697
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146997.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14700---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014701
14702Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14703they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14704possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14705passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14706the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014707the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14708match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014709
14710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147117.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14712-------------------------------------
14713
14714It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14715not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14716a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14717to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14718digits may be used upper or lower case.
14719
14720Example :
14721 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14722 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14723
14724
147257.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14726---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014727
14728IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14729netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14730within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014731host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014732difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14733at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14734does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14735parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014736
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014737The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14738abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14739
14740 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14741 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14742 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14743 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14744 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14745 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14746 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14747 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14748
14749Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14750192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14751
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014752IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14753Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14754trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14755IPv6 patterns.
14756
14757HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14758following situations :
14759 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14760 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14761 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14762 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14763 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14764 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14765 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14766 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14767 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14768 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014770
147717.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14772----------------------------------
14773
14774Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14775combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14776
14777 - AND (implicit)
14778 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14779 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014783 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014785Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14786indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14789"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14790requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14791is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14792
14793 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014794 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14795 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14796 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014797
14798To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14799and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14800
14801 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14802 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14803 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14804 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14805
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014806 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14808 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14809 use_backend www if host_www
14810
14811It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14812expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14813be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14814the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14815
14816 The following rule :
14817
14818 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014819 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820
14821 Can also be written that way :
14822
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014823 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824
14825It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14826to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14827simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14828sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14829good use is the following :
14830
14831 With named ACLs :
14832
14833 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14834 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14835 monitor fail if site_dead
14836
14837 With anonymous ACLs :
14838
14839 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14840
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014841See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14842keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014843
14844
148457.3. Fetching samples
14846---------------------
14847
14848Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14849against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14850sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14851ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14852of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14853available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14854
14855This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14856Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14857compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14858deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14859
14860The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14861matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14862method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14863indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14864
14865As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14866when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14867mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14868the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14869ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14870
14871Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14872multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14873when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014874incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14875are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14877all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14878
14879Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14880 - name
14881 - name(arg1)
14882 - name(arg1,arg2)
14883
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014884
148857.3.1. Converters
14886-----------------
14887
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014888Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14889of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14890is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14891was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014892has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014893unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14894
14895These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14896sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14897the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014898support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014899
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014900A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14901support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14902supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14903(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14904bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014906The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014907
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001490851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14909 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14910 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14911 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14912 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14913 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14914
14915 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014916 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14917 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014918 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14919 frontend http-in
14920 bind *:8081
14921 default_backend servers
14922 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14923 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14924
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014925add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014926 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014927 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014928 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14929 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014930 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014931 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14932 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14933 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14934 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014935 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014936 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014937
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014938aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14939 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14940 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14941 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14942 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14943 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14944 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14945
14946 Example:
14947 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14948 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14949
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014950and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014951 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014952 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014953 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14954 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014955 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014956 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14957 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14958 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14959 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014960 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014961 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014962
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014963b64dec
14964 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14965 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14966
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014967base64
14968 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014969 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014970 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14971
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014972bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014973 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014974 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014975 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014976 presence of a flag).
14977
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014978bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14979 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14980 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014981 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014982
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014983concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14984 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14985 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14986 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14987 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14988 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14989 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14990 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14991 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14992 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14993 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014994 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014995 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014996 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14997 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014998
14999 Example:
15000 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15001 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15002 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015003 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015004 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15005
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015006cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015007 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15008 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015009
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015010crc32([<avalanche>])
15011 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15012 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15013 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15014 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15015 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15016 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15017 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15018 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15019 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15020 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015021 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15022
15023crc32c([<avalanche>])
15024 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15025 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15026 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15027 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15028 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15029 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15030 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15031 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015032
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015033cut_crlf
15034 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15035 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15036 updated.
15037
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015038da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015039 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15040 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15041 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15042 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015043 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015044 configuration language.
15045
15046 Example:
15047 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015048 bind *:8881
15049 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015050 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015051
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015052debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15053 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15054 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15055 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15056 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15057 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15058 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15059 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15060 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15061 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15062 printable sample types.
15063
15064 Example:
15065 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015066
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015067digest(<algorithm>)
15068 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15069 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15070
15071 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15072 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15073
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015074div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015075 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15076 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015077 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015078 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15079 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015080 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015081 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15082 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15083 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15084 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015085 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015086 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015087
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015088djb2([<avalanche>])
15089 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15090 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15091 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15092 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15093 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15094 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15095 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015096 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15097 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015098
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015099even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015100 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015101 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15102
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015103field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15104 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15105 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15106 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15107 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15108 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15109 fields.
15110
15111 Example :
15112 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15113 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15114 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15115 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15116 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015117
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015118hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015119 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015120 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015121 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015122 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015123
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015124hex2i
15125 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015126 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015127
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015128htonl
15129 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15130 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15131 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15132 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15133
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015134hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15135 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15136 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15137 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15138 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15139
15140 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15141 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15142
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015143http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015144 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15145 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015146 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15147 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15148 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15149 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15150 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15151 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15152 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15153 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015154
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015155iif(<true>,<false>)
15156 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15157 string otherwise.
15158
15159 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015160 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015161
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015162in_table(<table>)
15163 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15164 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15165 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015166 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015167 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15168
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015169ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15170 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015171 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015172 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15173 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15174 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15175 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15176 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015177
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015178json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015179 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015180 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015181 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015182 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15183 of errors:
15184 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15185 bytes, ...)
15186 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15187 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15188
15189 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15190 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15191 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15192 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15193 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15194 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015195 - "ascii" : never fails;
15196 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15197 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015198 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015199 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015200 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15201 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15202
15203 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015204 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015205
15206 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015207 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015208 capture request header user-agent len 150
15209 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015210
15211 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15212 GET / HTTP/1.0
15213 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15214
15215 Output log:
15216 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15217
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015218language(<value>[,<default>])
15219 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15220 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15221 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15222 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15223 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15224 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15225 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15226 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15227 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015228 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015229 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15230 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015231
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015232 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015233
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015234 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15235 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015236
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015237 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15238 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15239 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15240 use_backend spanish if es
15241 use_backend french if fr
15242 use_backend english if en
15243 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015244
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015245length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015246 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15247 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15248 type. The result is of type integer.
15249
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015250lower
15251 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15252 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15253 type. The result is of type string.
15254
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015255ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15256 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15257 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15258 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15259 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15260 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15261 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15262
15263 Example :
15264
15265 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015266 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015267 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15268
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015269ltrim(<chars>)
15270 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15271 representation of the input sample.
15272
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015273map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15274map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15275map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15276 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15277 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15278 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15279 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15280 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15281 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15282 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15283 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015284
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015285 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15286 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15287 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015288
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015289 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015290 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015291
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015292 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15293 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15294 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15295 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015296 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15297 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015298 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15299 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15300 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15301 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15302 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15303 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15304 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15305 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015306 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15307 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15308 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015309 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15310 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15311 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15312 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15313 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015314
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015315 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15316 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15317 the corresponding match text.
15318
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015319 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15320 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15321 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15322 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15323 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015324
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015325 Example :
15326
15327 # this is a comment and is ignored
15328 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15329 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15330 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15331 | | | `---------- value
15332 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15333 | `---------------------------- key
15334 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15335
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015336mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015337 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15338 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015339 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015340 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015341 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015342 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15343 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15344 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15345 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015346 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015347 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015348
15349mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015350 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015351 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15352 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015353 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015354 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015355 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015356 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15357 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15358 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15359 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015360 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015361 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015362
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015363nbsrv
15364 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15365 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15366 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15367 map lookup.
15368
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015369neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015370 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15371 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15372 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15373 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015374
15375not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015376 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015377 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015378 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015379 absence of a flag).
15380
15381odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015382 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015383 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15384
15385or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015386 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015387 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015388 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15389 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015390 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015391 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15392 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15393 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15394 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015395 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015396 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015397
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015398protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15399 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15400 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15401 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15402 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15403 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15404 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15405 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15406 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15407 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15408 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15409 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15410
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015411regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015412 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15413 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15414 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15415 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15416 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15417 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15418 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15419 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15420 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015421 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15422 of characters with other ones.
15423
15424 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15425 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15426 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15427 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15428 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15429 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015430
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015431 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015432
15433 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15434 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15435 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015436 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015437
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015438 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15439 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15440
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015441 # capture groups and backreferences
15442 # both lines do the same.
15443 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15444 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15445
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015446capture-req(<id>)
15447 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15448 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15449
15450 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015451 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15452 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015453
15454capture-res(<id>)
15455 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15456 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15457
15458 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015459 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15460 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015461
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015462rtrim(<chars>)
15463 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15464 of the input sample.
15465
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015466sdbm([<avalanche>])
15467 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15468 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15469 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15470 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15471 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15472 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15473 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015474 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15475 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015476
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015477secure_memcmp(<var>)
15478 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15479 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15480 match.
15481
15482 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15483 performed in constant time.
15484
15485 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15486 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15487
15488 Example :
15489
15490 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15491 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15492 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15493 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15494
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015495set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015496 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15497 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15498 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015499 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015500 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15501 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015502 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015503 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15504 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015505 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015506 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015507
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015508sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015509 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015510 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15511
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015512sha2([<bits>])
15513 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15514 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15515
15516 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15517 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15518
15519 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15520 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15521
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015522srv_queue
15523 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15524 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15525 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15526 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15527 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15528
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015529strcmp(<var>)
15530 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15531 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15532 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15533 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15534 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15535 shorter).
15536
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015537 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15538 strings in constant time.
15539
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015540 Example :
15541
15542 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15543 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15544 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15545
15546
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015547sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015548 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15549 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015550 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015551 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15552 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015553 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015554 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15555 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015556 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015557 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15558 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015559 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015560 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015561
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015562table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15563 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15564 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15565 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15566 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15567 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15568 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15569
15570
15571table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15572 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15573 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15574 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15575 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15576 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15577 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15578
15579table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15580 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15581 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015582 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015583 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15584 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15585
15586table_conn_cur(<table>)
15587 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15588 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15589 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15590 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15591 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15592
15593table_conn_rate(<table>)
15594 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15595 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15596 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15597 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15598 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15599
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015600table_gpt0(<table>)
15601 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15602 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15603 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15604 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15605 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15606
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015607table_gpc0(<table>)
15608 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15609 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15610 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15611 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15612 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15613
15614table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15615 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15616 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15617 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15618 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15619 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15620 sample fetch keyword.
15621
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015622table_gpc1(<table>)
15623 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15624 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15625 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15626 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15627 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15628
15629table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15630 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15631 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15632 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15633 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15634 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15635 sample fetch keyword.
15636
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015637table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15638 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15639 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015640 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015641 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15642 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15643
15644table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15645 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15646 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15647 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15648 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15649 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15650 keyword.
15651
15652table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15653 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15654 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015655 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015656 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15657 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15658
15659table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15660 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15661 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15662 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15663 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15664 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15665 keyword.
15666
15667table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15668 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15669 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015670 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015671 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15672 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15673 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15674 keyword.
15675
15676table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15677 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15678 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015679 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015680 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15681 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15682 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15683 keyword.
15684
15685table_server_id(<table>)
15686 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15687 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15688 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15689 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15690 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15691 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15692
15693table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15694 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15695 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015696 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015697 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15698 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15699 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15700 keyword.
15701
15702table_sess_rate(<table>)
15703 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15704 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15705 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15706 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15707 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15708 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15709 keyword.
15710
15711table_trackers(<table>)
15712 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15713 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15714 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15715 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15716 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15717 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15718 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15719 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15720 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15721 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15722
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015723upper
15724 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15725 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15726 type. The result is of type string.
15727
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015728url_dec([<in_form>])
15729 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15730 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15731 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15732 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15733 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15734 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015735
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015736ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015737 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015738 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15739 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15740 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015741 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15742 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15743 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15744 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015745 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015746 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15747 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015748
15749 Example:
15750 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15751 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15752
15753 message Point {
15754 int32 latitude = 1;
15755 int32 longitude = 2;
15756 }
15757
15758 message PPoint {
15759 Point point = 59;
15760 }
15761
15762 message Rectangle {
15763 // One corner of the rectangle.
15764 PPoint lo = 48;
15765 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15766 PPoint hi = 49;
15767 }
15768
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015769 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15770 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15771 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015772
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015773 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15774 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015775 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015776 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15777
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015778 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015779
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015780 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015781
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015782 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15783 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15784 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015785
15786 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15787 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15788 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15789
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015790 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15791 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15792 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015793
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015794
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015795unset-var(<var name>)
15796 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15797 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15798 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15799 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15800 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15801 response),
15802 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15803 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15804 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15805 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15806
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015807utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15808 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15809 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15810 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15811 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15812 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15813 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15814
15815 Example :
15816
15817 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015818 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015819 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15820
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015821word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15822 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15823 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15824 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015825 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015826 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15827 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15828
15829 Example :
15830 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15831 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15832 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15833 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15834 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015835 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015836
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015837wt6([<avalanche>])
15838 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15839 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15840 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15841 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15842 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15843 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15844 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015845 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15846 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015847
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015848xor(<value>)
15849 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015850 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015851 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015852 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015853 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015854 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15855 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015856 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015857 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15858 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015859 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015860 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015861
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015862xxh32([<seed>])
15863 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15864 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15865 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15866 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15867 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15868 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15869 as cryptographically secure.
15870
15871xxh64([<seed>])
15872 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15873 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15874 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15875 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15876 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15877 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15878 as cryptographically secure.
15879
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015880
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158817.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015882--------------------------------------------
15883
15884A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15885not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15886"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15887The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15888
15889always_false : boolean
15890 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15891 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15892
15893always_true : boolean
15894 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15895 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15896
15897avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015898 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15900 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15901 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15902 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15903 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15904 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15905 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15906 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15907 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15908 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15909 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15910 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15911 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015914 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15915 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15916 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15917 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015918 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15919
15920be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15922 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15923 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15924 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15925 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015926 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15927 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015928
15929 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15930 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15931 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15934 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15935 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15936 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015937 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15939 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015940
15941 Example :
15942 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15943 backend dynamic
15944 mode http
15945 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15946 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015947
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015948bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015949 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15950 of the string.
15951
15952bool(<bool>) : bool
15953 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15954 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15957 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015958 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15960 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015961
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015962 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015963 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015964 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15965
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015966 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15967 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015968
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015969 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015970 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015971 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015972 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015973 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015975 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015976
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015977 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15978 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015980 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015981
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015982cpu_calls : integer
15983 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15984 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15985 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15986 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15987 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15988 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15989
15990cpu_ns_avg : integer
15991 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15992 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15993 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15994 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15995 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15996 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15997 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15998 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15999 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16000 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16001 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16002
16003cpu_ns_tot : integer
16004 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16005 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16006 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16007 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16008 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16009 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16010 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16011 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16012 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16013 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16014 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16015 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16016 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16017
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016018date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016019 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016020
16021 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16022 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16023 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016024 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16025
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016026 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16027 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16028 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16029 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16030 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16031
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016032 Example :
16033
16034 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16035 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016036
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016037 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16038 # millisecond granularity
16039 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16040
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016041date_us : integer
16042 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16043 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16044 from the same timeval structure.
16045
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016046distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16047 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16048 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16049 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16050 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16051 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16052 list of supported tokens.
16053
16054distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16055 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16056 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16057 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16058 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16059 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16060 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16061 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16062 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16063 supported tokens.
16064
16065 Example :
16066 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16067 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16068 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16069 # send large files to the big farm
16070 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16071
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016072env(<name>) : string
16073 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16074 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16075 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16076 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16077 certain way.
16078
16079 Examples :
16080 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16081 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16082
16083 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16084 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016086fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16087 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016088 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16089 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16091 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016092 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016093 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16094 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016095
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016096fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16097 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16098 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16099 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16102 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16103 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16104 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16105 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16106 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16107 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16108 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16109 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016110
16111 Example :
16112 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16113 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16114 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16115 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16116 frontend mail
16117 bind :25
16118 mode tcp
16119 maxconn 100
16120 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16121 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16122 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16123 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016124
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016125hostname : string
16126 Returns the system hostname.
16127
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016128int(<integer>) : signed integer
16129 Returns a signed integer.
16130
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016131ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16132 Returns an ipv4.
16133
16134ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16135 Returns an ipv6.
16136
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016137lat_ns_avg : integer
16138 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16139 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16140 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16141 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16142 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16143 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16144 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16145 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16146 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016147 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16148 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16149 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16150 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16151 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16152 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016153
16154lat_ns_tot : integer
16155 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16156 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16157 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16158 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16159 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16160 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16161 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16162 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16163 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016164 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16165 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16166 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16167 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16168 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016169 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16170 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16171 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16172 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16173 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16174 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16175
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016176meth(<method>) : method
16177 Returns a method.
16178
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016179nbproc : integer
16180 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16181 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16182 and debugging purposes.
16183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016184nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16185 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16186 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16187 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016188 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16189 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16190 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016191
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016192prio_class : integer
16193 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16194 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16195 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16196
16197prio_offset : integer
16198 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16199 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16200 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16201 set-priority-offset".
16202
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016203proc : integer
16204 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16205 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16206 debugging purposes.
16207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016209 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16210 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16211 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016212 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16213 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16214 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16215 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16216 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16217
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016218rand([<range>]) : integer
16219 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16220 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16221 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16222 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16223 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16224
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016225uuid([<version>]) : string
16226 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16227 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16228 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016230srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16231 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16232 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16233 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16234 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16235 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016236 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16237 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16238
16239srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16240 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16241 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16242 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16243 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16244 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16245 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16246 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16247
16248 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16249 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250
16251srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16252 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16253 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16254 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016255 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016256 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16257 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16258 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16259
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016260srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16261 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16262 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16263 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16264 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16265 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16266 fetch methods.
16267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016268srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16269 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16270 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016271 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016272 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16273 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016274 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016275 overloading servers).
16276
16277 Example :
16278 # Redirect to a separate back
16279 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16280 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16281 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16282
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016283srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16284 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16285 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16286 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16287
16288srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16289 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16290 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16291 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16292
16293srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16294 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16295 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16296 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16297
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016298stopping : boolean
16299 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16300 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16301 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16302
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016303str(<string>) : string
16304 Returns a string.
16305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016306table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16307 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16308 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16309
16310table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16311 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16312 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16313 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16314
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016315thread : integer
16316 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16317 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16318 and debugging purposes.
16319
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016320var(<var-name>) : undefined
16321 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016322 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16323 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016324 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016325 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16326 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016327 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016328 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16329 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016330 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016331 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016332
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163337.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016334----------------------------------
16335
16336The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16337closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16338methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16339sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16340TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016341the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16342counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016343"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16344used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16345can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16346Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16347table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16348tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16349currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016350
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016351bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016352 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16353 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16354 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016356be_id : integer
16357 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016358 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16359 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016360
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016361be_name : string
16362 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016363 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16364 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016366dst : ip
16367 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16368 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16369 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16370 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016371 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16372 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16373 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16374 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16375 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16376 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377
16378dst_conn : integer
16379 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16380 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16381 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16382 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16383 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16384 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16385 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16386 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016387
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016388dst_is_local : boolean
16389 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16390 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16391 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16392 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016393 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016394 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16395 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16396 it only once per connection.
16397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016398dst_port : integer
16399 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16400 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16401 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16402 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16403 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16404 an HTTP header.
16405
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016406fc_http_major : integer
16407 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16408 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16409 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16410
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016411fc_pp_authority : string
16412 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16413 if any.
16414
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016415fc_pp_unique_id : string
16416 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16417 if any.
16418
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016419fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16420 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16421 header.
16422
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016423fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16424 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16425 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16426 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16427 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16428 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16429 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16430
16431fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16432 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16433 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16434 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16435 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16436 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16437 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16438
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016439fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016440 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16441 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16442 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16443 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16444
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016445fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016446 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16447 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16448 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16449 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16450
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016451fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016452 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16453 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16454 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16455 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16456
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016457fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016458 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16459 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16460 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16461 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16462
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016463fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016464 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16465 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16466 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16467 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16468
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016469fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016470 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16471 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16472 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16473 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16474
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016475fe_defbe : string
16476 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16477 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479fe_id : integer
16480 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016481 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016482 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16483
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016484fe_name : string
16485 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16486 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16487 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16488
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016489sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016490sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16491sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16492sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016493 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16494 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16495 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16496
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016497sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016498sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16499sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16500sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016501 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16502 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16503 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16504
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016505sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016506sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16507sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16508sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016509 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16510 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016511 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16512 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16513 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016514
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016515 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016516 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16517 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016518 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16519 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16520 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016521 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16522 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16523
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016524sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16525sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16526sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16527sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16528 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16529 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16530 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16531 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16532 when a first ACL was verified.
16533
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016534sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016535sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16536sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16537sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016538 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016539 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16540
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016541sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016542sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16543sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16544sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016545 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16546 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16547 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16548
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016549sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016550sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16551sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16552sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016553 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16554 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16555 See also src_conn_rate.
16556
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016557sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016558sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16559sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16560sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016561 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016562 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016563
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016564sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16565sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16566sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16567sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16568 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16569 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16570
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016571sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16572sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16573sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16574sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16575 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16576 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16577
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016578sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016579sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16580sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16581sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016582 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16583 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16584 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016585 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16586 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16587 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016588
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016589sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16590sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16591sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16592sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16593 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16594 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16595 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16596 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16597 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16598 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16599
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016600sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016601sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16602sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16603sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016604 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016605 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16606 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16607
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016608sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016609sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16610sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16611sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016612 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16613 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16614 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16615 src_http_err_rate.
16616
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016617sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016618sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16619sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16620sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016621 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016622 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16623 src_http_req_cnt.
16624
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016625sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016626sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16627sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16628sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016629 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16630 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16631 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16632 src_http_req_rate.
16633
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016634sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016635sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16636sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16637sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016638 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016639 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16640 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16641 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16642 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016643
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016644 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016645 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16646 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016647 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16648
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016649sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16650sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16651sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16652sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16653 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16654 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16655 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16656 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16657 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16658
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016659sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016660sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16661sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16662sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016663 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16664 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16665 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016666
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016667sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016668sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16669sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16670sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016671 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16672 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16673 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016674
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016675sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016676sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16677sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16678sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016679 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016680 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16681 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16682 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016683 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016684 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16685
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016686sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016687sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16688sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16689sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016690 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16691 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16692 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16693 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16694 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016695 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016696
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016697sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016698sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16699sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16700sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016701 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16702 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16703 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16704
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016705sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016706sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16707sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16708sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016709 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16710 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016711 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016712 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16713 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016714 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16715 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16716 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016718so_id : integer
16719 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16720 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16721 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016722
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016723so_name : string
16724 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16725 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16726 strings instead of integers.
16727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016728src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016729 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16731 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16732 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016733 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16734 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16735 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016736 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16737 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16738 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16739 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16740 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16741 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16742 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016743
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016744 Example:
16745 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16746 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016748src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16749 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16750 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16751 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016752 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16755 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16756 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016757 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016758 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016760src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16761 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16762 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16763 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16764 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16765 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16766 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016767
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016768 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016769 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16770 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16771 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16772 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016773 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016774 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16775 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16776
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016777src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16778 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16779 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16780 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16781 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16782 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16783 was verified.
16784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016785src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016786 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016787 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016788 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016789 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016791src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016792 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016793 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16794 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016795 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016797src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16798 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16799 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16800 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016801 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016804 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016805 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016806 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016807 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016808
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016809src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16810 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16811 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16812 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16813 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16814
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016815src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16816 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16817 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16818 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16819 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016822 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016823 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016824 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16825 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016826 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16827 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16828 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016829
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016830src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16831 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16832 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16833 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16834 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16835 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16836 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16837 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016840 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016841 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016842 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016843 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016844 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016846src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16847 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16848 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16849 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16850 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016851 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016853src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016854 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016855 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16856 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016857 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016859src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16860 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16861 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16862 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016863 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016864 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016866src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16867 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16868 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16869 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016870 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016871 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16872 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016873
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016874 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016875 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016876 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016877 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016878
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016879src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16880 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16881 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16882 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16883 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16884 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16885 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16886
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016887src_is_local : boolean
16888 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16889 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16890 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16891 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016892 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016893 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16894 once per connection.
16895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016896src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016897 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16898 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16899 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16900 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16901 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016903src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016904 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16905 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16906 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16907 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16908 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016910src_port : integer
16911 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16912 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16913 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16914 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016916src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016917 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016918 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16919 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16920 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016921 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016923src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16924 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16925 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16926 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16927 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016928 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016930src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16931 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16932 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16933 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16934 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16935 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16936 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16937 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16938 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016939
16940 Example :
16941 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16942 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16943 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16944 listen ssh
16945 bind :22
16946 mode tcp
16947 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016948 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016949 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016950 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016952srv_id : integer
16953 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16954 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016955 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016956
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016957srv_name : string
16958 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16959 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016960 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169627.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016963----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016965The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16966closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16967when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16968usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016969future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016970
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001697151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16972 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16973 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16974 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16975 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16976 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16977
16978 Example :
16979 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16980 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16981 # the request.
16982 frontend http-in
16983 bind *:8081
16984 default_backend servers
16985 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16986 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16987
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016988ssl_bc : boolean
16989 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16990 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016991 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16992 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016993
16994ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16995 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016996 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16997 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016998
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016999ssl_bc_alpn : string
17000 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17001 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017002 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017003 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17004 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17005 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17006 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17007 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017008 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17009 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017010
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017011ssl_bc_cipher : string
17012 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017013 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17014 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017015
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017016ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17017 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17018 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17019 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017020 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017021
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017022ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17023 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17024 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017025 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17026 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017027
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017028ssl_bc_npn : string
17029 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17030 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017031 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017032 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17033 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17034 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17035 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017036 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17037 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017038
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017039ssl_bc_protocol : string
17040 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017041 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17042 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017043
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017044ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017045 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017046 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017047 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17048 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017049
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017050ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17051 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17052 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17053 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017054 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017055
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017056ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17057 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17058 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017059 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17060 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017061
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017062ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17063 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17064 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17065 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017066 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017067
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017068ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17069 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017070 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17071 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017073ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17074 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17075 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17076 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17077 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17078 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017080ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17081 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17082 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17083 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17084 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017085
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017086ssl_c_der : binary
17087 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17088 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17089 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17090
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017091ssl_c_der_chain : binary
17092 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17093 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17094 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17095 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17096 does not support resumed sessions.
17097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017098ssl_c_err : integer
17099 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17100 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17101 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17102 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17103 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017104
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017105ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017106 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17107 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17108 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17109 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17110 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17111 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17112 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17113 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017114 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17115 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17116 LDAP v3.
17117 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17118 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017120ssl_c_key_alg : string
17121 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17122 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17123 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017125ssl_c_notafter : string
17126 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17127 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17128 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130ssl_c_notbefore : string
17131 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17132 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17133 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017134
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017135ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017136 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17137 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17138 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17139 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17140 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17141 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17142 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17143 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017144 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17145 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17146 LDAP v3.
17147 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17148 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017150ssl_c_serial : binary
17151 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17152 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17153 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017155ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17156 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17157 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17158 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017159 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17160 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17161
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017162 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017163 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017165ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17166 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17167 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17168 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017170ssl_c_used : boolean
17171 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17172 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017174ssl_c_verify : integer
17175 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17176 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17177 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17178 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017180ssl_c_version : integer
17181 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17182 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017183
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017184ssl_f_der : binary
17185 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17186 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17187 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17188
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017189ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017190 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17191 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17192 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17193 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017194 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017195 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17196 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17197 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017198 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17199 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17200 LDAP v3.
17201 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17202 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017204ssl_f_key_alg : string
17205 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17206 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17207 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017209ssl_f_notafter : string
17210 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17211 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17212 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017214ssl_f_notbefore : string
17215 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17216 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17217 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017218
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017219ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017220 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17221 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17222 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17223 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17224 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17225 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17226 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17227 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017228 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17229 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17230 LDAP v3.
17231 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17232 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017234ssl_f_serial : binary
17235 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17236 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17237 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017238
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017239ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17240 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17241 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17242 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017244ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17245 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17246 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17247 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017249ssl_f_version : integer
17250 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17251 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17252
17253ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017254 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17255 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17256 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017258 Example :
17259 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17260 listen http-https
17261 bind :80
17262 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17263 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17264
17265ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17266 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17267 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17268
17269ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017270 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017271 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17272 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17273 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17274 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17275 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17276 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17277 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17278 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017280ssl_fc_cipher : string
17281 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17282 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017283
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017284ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17285 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17286 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017287 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017288
17289ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17290 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17291 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017292 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017293
17294ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17295 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17296 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17297 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017298 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017299 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017300
17301ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17302 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17303 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017304 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017305
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017306ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17307 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17308 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17309 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17310
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017311ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17312 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17313 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17314 transport layer.
17315 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17316 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17317 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17318 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17319
17320ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17321 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17322 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17323 transport layer.
17324 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17325 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17326 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17327 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17328
17329ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17330 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17331 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17332 transport layer.
17333 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17334 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17335 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17336 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17337
17338ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17339 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17340 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17341 transport layer.
17342 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17343 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17344 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17345 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17346
17347ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17348 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17349 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17350 transport layer.
17351 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17352 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17353 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17354 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017356ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017357 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17358 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017359 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17360 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17361 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17362 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017363
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017364ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17365 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17366 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17367 wait until the handshake happened.
17368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017369ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17370 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017371 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17372 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017373 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017374 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017375
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017376ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017377 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017378 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17379 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017381ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017382 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017383 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17384 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17385 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17386 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17387 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17388 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17389 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017391ssl_fc_protocol : string
17392 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17393 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017394
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017395ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017396 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017397 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17398 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017399
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017400ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17401 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17402 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17403 transport layer.
17404 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17405 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17406 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17407 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17408
17409ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17410 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17411 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17412 transport layer.
17413 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17414 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17415 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17416 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17417
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017418ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17419 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17420 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17421 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017423ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17424 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17425 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17426 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17427 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017428
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017429ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17430 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17431 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17432 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17433 BoringSSL.
17434
17435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017436ssl_fc_sni : string
17437 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17438 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17439 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17440 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17441 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17442
17443 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17444 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17445 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017446 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017447 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017449 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017450 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17451 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017453ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17454 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17455 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017456
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017457ssl_s_der : binary
17458 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17459 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17460 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17461
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017462ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17463 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17464 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17465 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17466 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17467 does not support resumed sessions.
17468
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017469ssl_s_key_alg : string
17470 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17471 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17472 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17473
17474ssl_s_notafter : string
17475 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17476 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17477 transport layer.
17478
17479ssl_s_notbefore : string
17480 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17481 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17482 transport layer.
17483
17484ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17485 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17486 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17487 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17488 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17489 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17490 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017491 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17492 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017493 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17494 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17495 LDAP v3.
17496 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17497 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17498
17499ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17500 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17501 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17502 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17503 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17504 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17505 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017506 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17507 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017508 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17509 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17510 LDAP v3.
17511 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17512 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17513
17514ssl_s_serial : binary
17515 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17516 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17517 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17518
17519ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17520 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17521 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17522 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17523
17524ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17525 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17526 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17527 layer.
17528
17529ssl_s_version : integer
17530 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17531 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017532
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175337.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017534------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017536Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17537sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17538only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17539For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17540be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17541can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17542sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17543for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17544content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017547 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017548 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17549 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017551payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17552 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017553 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017554 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017555
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017556req.hdrs : string
17557 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17558 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17559 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17560 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17561
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017562req.hdrs_bin : binary
17563 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17564 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17565 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17566 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17567 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17568 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17569
17570 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17571
17572 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17573 str: <int:length><bytes>
17574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017575req.len : integer
17576req_len : integer (deprecated)
17577 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17578 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17579 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17580 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17581 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17582 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17583 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17584 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017586req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17587 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017588 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17589 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17590 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17591 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017593 ACL alternatives :
17594 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17597 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17598 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17599 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17600 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017602 ACL alternatives :
17603 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017605 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017607req.proto_http : boolean
17608req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17609 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17610 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17611 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17612 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17613 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17614 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17615 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017617 Example:
17618 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17619 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17620 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017621 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017623req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17624rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17625 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17626 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17627 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17628 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17629 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17630 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17631 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017633 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17634 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17635 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17636 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17637 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17638 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017640 ACL derivatives :
17641 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017643 Example :
17644 listen tse-farm
17645 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17646 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17647 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17648 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17649 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17650 persist rdp-cookie
17651 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17652 # This is only useful makes sense if
17653 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17654 stick-table type string size 204800
17655 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17656 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17657 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017659 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17660 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017662req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17663rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17664 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17665 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17666 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17667 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017669 ACL derivatives :
17670 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017671
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017672req.ssl_alpn : string
17673 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17674 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17675 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17676 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17677 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17678 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017679 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017680
17681 Examples :
17682 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17683 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17684 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017685 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017686 default_backend bk_default
17687
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017688req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17689 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17690 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017691 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17692 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17693 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17694 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17695 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017697req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17698req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17699 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17700 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17701 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17702 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17703 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17704 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17705 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017707req.ssl_sni : string
17708req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17709 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17710 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17711 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17712 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17713 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017714 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17715 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17716 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17717 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17718 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17719 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17720 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17721 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17722 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017724 ACL derivatives :
17725 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017727 Examples :
17728 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17729 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17730 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17731 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17732 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017733
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017734req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17735 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17736 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17737 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17738 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17739 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17740 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17741 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17742 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17743 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017745req.ssl_ver : integer
17746req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17747 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17748 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17749 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17750 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17751 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17752 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17753 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017754 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017755 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017757 ACL derivatives :
17758 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017759
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017760res.len : integer
17761 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17762 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17763 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17764 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17765 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17766 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17767 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017768 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017770res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17771 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017772 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017773 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017774 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017775 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017777res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17778 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17779 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17780 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017781 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17782 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017784 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017785
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017786res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17787rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17788 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17789 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17790 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17791 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17792 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17793 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17794 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017796wait_end : boolean
17797 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17798 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017799 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017800 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17801 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017802 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017803 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17804 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017806 Examples :
17807 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17808 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17809 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017811 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17812 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17813 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17814 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17815 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17816 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17817 tcp-request content reject
17818
17819
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178207.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017821--------------------------------------
17822
17823It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17824This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17825data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17826its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17827HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17828content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17829to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17830more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17831response are indexed.
17832
17833base : string
17834 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17835 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17836 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17837 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17838 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17839 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17840 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17841 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17842
17843 ACL derivatives :
17844 base : exact string match
17845 base_beg : prefix match
17846 base_dir : subdir match
17847 base_dom : domain match
17848 base_end : suffix match
17849 base_len : length match
17850 base_reg : regex match
17851 base_sub : substring match
17852
17853base32 : integer
17854 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17855 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17856 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017857 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17858 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17859 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017860
17861base32+src : binary
17862 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17863 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17864 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17865 per-URL counters.
17866
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017867capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17868 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17869 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17870 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17871
17872capture.req.method : string
17873 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17874 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17875 because it's allocated.
17876
17877capture.req.uri : string
17878 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17879 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17880 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17881 allocated.
17882
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017883capture.req.ver : string
17884 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17885 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17886 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17887
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017888capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17889 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17890 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17891 The first entry is an index of 0.
17892 See also: "capture response header"
17893
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017894capture.res.ver : string
17895 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17896 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17897 persistent flag.
17898
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017899req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017900 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17901 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17902 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017903
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017904req.body_param([<name>) : string
17905 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17906 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17907 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17908 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17909 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17910 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17911 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17912 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17913 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17914 given.
17915
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017916req.body_len : integer
17917 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17918 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017919 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17920 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017921
17922req.body_size : integer
17923 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017924 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17925 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017927req.cook([<name>]) : string
17928cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17929 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17930 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17931 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17932 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17933 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17934 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17935 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17936 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17937
17938 ACL derivatives :
17939 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17940 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17941 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17942 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17943 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17944 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17945 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17946 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017948req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17949cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17950 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17951 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017953req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17954cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17955 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17956 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17957 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17958 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017960cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17961 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17962 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17963 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17964 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017965 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017966 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17967 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17968 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17969 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017971hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17972 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17973 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17974 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17975 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017976 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017978req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17979 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17980 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17981 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17982 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17983 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17984 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17985 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17986 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017988req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17989 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17990 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17991 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17992 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017994req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17995 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17996 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17997 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17998 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17999 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18000 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18001 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18002 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018003 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018004 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018005 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018007 ACL derivatives :
18008 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18009 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18010 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18011 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18012 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18013 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18014 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18015 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18016
18017req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18018hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18019 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18020 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18021 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18022 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18023 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18024 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18025 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18026 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18027 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18028
18029req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18030hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18031 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18032 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18033 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18034 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18035 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018036 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018037 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18038 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18039
18040req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18041hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18042 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18043 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18044 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18045 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18046 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18047 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18048 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18049
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018050
18051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018052http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18053 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18054 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18055 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18056 basic auth is supported.
18057
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018058http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18059 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18060 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18061 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18062 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018063 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18064 basic auth is supported.
18065
18066 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018067 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18068 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18069 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18070 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018071
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018072http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018073 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18074 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18075 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018076
18077http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018078 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18079 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18080 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018081
18082http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018083 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18084 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18085 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018087http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018088 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18089 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018090 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18091 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018093method : integer + string
18094 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18095 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18096 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18097 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18098 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18099 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18100 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018102 ACL derivatives :
18103 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018105 Example :
18106 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18107 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18108 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018110path : string
18111 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18112 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18113 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18114 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18115 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018116 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018117 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018119 ACL derivatives :
18120 path : exact string match
18121 path_beg : prefix match
18122 path_dir : subdir match
18123 path_dom : domain match
18124 path_end : suffix match
18125 path_len : length match
18126 path_reg : regex match
18127 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018128
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018129pathq : string
18130 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18131 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18132 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18133 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18134 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18135 result in both cases.
18136
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018137query : string
18138 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18139 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18140 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18141 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018142 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018143 which stops before the question mark.
18144
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018145req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18146 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18147 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18148 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18149 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018151req.ver : string
18152req_ver : string (deprecated)
18153 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18154 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18155 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018157 ACL derivatives :
18158 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018159
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018160res.body : binary
18161 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18162 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18163 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18164 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18165
18166res.body_len : integer
18167 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18168 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18169 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18170 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18171
18172res.body_size : integer
18173 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18174 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18175 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18176 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18177 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18178 based expect rules.
18179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018180res.comp : boolean
18181 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18182 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18183 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018185res.comp_algo : string
18186 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18187 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18188 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018190res.cook([<name>]) : string
18191scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18192 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18193 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018194 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18195 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018197 ACL derivatives :
18198 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018200res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18201scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18202 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18203 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018204 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18205 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018207res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18208scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18209 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18210 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018211 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18212 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018214res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18215 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18216 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18217 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18218 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18219 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18220 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18221 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18222 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018223 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018225res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18226 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18227 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18228 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18229 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018230 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18231 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018233res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18234shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18235 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18236 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18237 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18238 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18239 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18240 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18241 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018242 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18243 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018245 ACL derivatives :
18246 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18247 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18248 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18249 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18250 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18251 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18252 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18253 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18254
18255res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18256shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18257 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18258 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18259 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18260 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018261 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018263res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18264shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18265 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18266 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18267 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18268 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18269 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018270 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18271 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018272
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018273res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18274 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18275 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18276 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018277 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18278 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018280res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18281shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18282 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18283 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18284 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18285 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18286 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018287 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18288 based expect rules.
18289
18290res.hdrs : string
18291 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18292 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18293 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18294 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18295 based expect rules.
18296
18297res.hdrs_bin : binary
18298 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18299 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18300 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18301 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18302 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18303 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18304 (length of 0 for both).
18305
18306 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18307
18308 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18309 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018311res.ver : string
18312resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18313 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018314 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18315 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018317 ACL derivatives :
18318 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018320set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18321 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18322 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018323 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018324 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018326 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18327 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018329status : integer
18330 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18331 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018332 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18333 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018334
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018335unique-id : string
18336 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18337 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18338 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18339 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18340 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18341 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018343url : string
18344 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18345 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18346 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18347 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18348 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18349 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18350 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018352 ACL derivatives :
18353 url : exact string match
18354 url_beg : prefix match
18355 url_dir : subdir match
18356 url_dom : domain match
18357 url_end : suffix match
18358 url_len : length match
18359 url_reg : regex match
18360 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018362url_ip : ip
18363 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18364 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18365 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18366 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18367 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18368 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18369 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371url_port : integer
18372 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18373 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18374 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18375 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018376
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018377urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18378url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018379 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18380 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018381 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18382 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18383 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18384 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018385 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18386 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018387 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18388 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018390 ACL derivatives :
18391 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18392 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18393 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18394 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18395 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18396 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18397 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18398 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018399
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018401 Example :
18402 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18403 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18404 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18405 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018406
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018407urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018408 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18409 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18410 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018411
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018412url32 : integer
18413 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18414 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18415 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18416 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18417 is an unsigned integer.
18418
18419url32+src : binary
18420 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18421 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18422 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18423
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018424
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200184257.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018426---------------------------------------
18427
18428This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18429used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18430purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18431There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18432or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18433any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18434for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18435
18436internal.htx.data : integer
18437 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18438 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18439
18440internal.htx.free : integer
18441 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18442 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18443
18444internal.htx.free_data : integer
18445 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18446 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18447
18448internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18449 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18450 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18451 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18452
18453internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18454 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18455 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18456
18457internal.htx.size : integer
18458 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18459 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18460
18461internal.htx.used : integer
18462 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18463 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18464 direction.
18465
18466internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18467 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18468 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18469 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18470 of the special value :
18471 * head : The oldest inserted block
18472 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018473 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018474
18475internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18476 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18477 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18478 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18479 integer or one of the special value :
18480 * head : The oldest inserted block
18481 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018482 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018483
18484internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18485 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18486 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18487 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18488 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18489
18490 * head : The oldest inserted block
18491 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018492 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018493
18494internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18495 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18496 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18497 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18498 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18499
18500 * head : The oldest inserted block
18501 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018502 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018503
18504internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18505 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18506 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18507 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18508 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18509
18510 * head : The oldest inserted block
18511 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018512 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018513
18514internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18515 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18516 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18517 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18518 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18519
18520 * head : The oldest inserted block
18521 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018522 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018523
18524internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18525 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18526 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18527 it returns false.
18528
18529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200185307.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018531---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018533Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18534every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018535order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018537ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18538---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018539FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018540HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018541HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18542HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018543HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18544HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18545HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18546HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18547LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018548METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018549METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018550METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18551METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18552METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18553METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018554METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018555METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018556RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018557REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018558TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018559WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18560---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018561
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185638. Logging
18564----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018565
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018566One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18567provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18568very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18569provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18570state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018571to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018572headers.
18573
18574In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18575about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18576send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18577
18578 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18579 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18580 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18581 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18582 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018583 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018584 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018585
18586The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18587allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18588as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18589while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18590real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18591delay.
18592
18593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185948.1. Log levels
18595---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018596
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018597TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018598source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018599HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18600in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18601track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18602syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18603about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018604
18605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186068.2. Log formats
18607----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018608
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018609HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018610and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18611slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18612options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018613
18614 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18615 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18616 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18617 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18618 extents.
18619
18620 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18621 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18622 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18623 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18624 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18625
18626 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18627 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18628 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18629 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18630 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18631
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018632 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18633 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18634 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18635 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18636
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018637 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18638
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018639Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18640specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18641field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18642servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18643always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18644identifier.
18645
18646Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18647 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18648 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18649 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18650 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18651
18652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186538.2.1. Default log format
18654-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018655
18656This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18657as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18658format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18659
18660 Example :
18661 listen www
18662 mode http
18663 log global
18664 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18665
18666 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18667 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18668 (www/HTTP)
18669
18670 Field Format Extract from the example above
18671 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18672 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18673 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18674 4 'to' to
18675 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18676 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18677
18678Detailed fields description :
18679 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18680 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18681 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18682 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18683 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18684 and processed the connection.
18685 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18686
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018687In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18688"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18689connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18690
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018691It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18692will eventually disappear.
18693
18694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186958.2.2. TCP log format
18696---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018697
18698The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18699is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18700information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18701counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18702emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18703environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18704the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18705sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018706specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18707not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18708fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18709marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018710
18711 Example :
18712 frontend fnt
18713 mode tcp
18714 option tcplog
18715 log global
18716 default_backend bck
18717
18718 backend bck
18719 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18720
18721 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18722 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18723 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18724
18725 Field Format Extract from the example above
18726 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18727 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18728 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18729 4 frontend_name fnt
18730 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18731 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18732 7 bytes_read* 212
18733 8 termination_state --
18734 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18735 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18736
18737Detailed fields description :
18738 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018739 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18740 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18741 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018742 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018743 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018744 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018745
18746 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018747 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18748 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18749 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018750
18751 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18752 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18753 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018754 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18755 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18756 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18757 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018758
18759 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18760 and processed the connection.
18761
18762 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18763 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18764 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18765 applications.
18766
18767 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18768 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18769 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18770 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18771 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18772
18773 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18774 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18775 See "Timers" below for more details.
18776
18777 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18778 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18779 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18780 "Timers" below for more details.
18781
18782 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018783 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018784 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18785 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18786 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18787 details.
18788
18789 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18790 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18791 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18792 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18793 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18794
18795 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18796 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18797 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18798 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18799 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18800 for more details.
18801
18802 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018803 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018804 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18805 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18806 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018807 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018808
18809 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18810 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18811 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18812 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18813 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18814 caused by a denial of service attack.
18815
18816 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18817 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18818 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18819 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18820 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18821 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18822 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18823 denial of service attack.
18824
18825 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18826 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18827 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18828 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18829 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18830 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18831 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18832 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18833 be processed than on other servers.
18834
18835 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18836 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18837 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18838 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18839 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18840 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18841 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18842 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18843 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18844 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18845 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18846 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18847 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18848
18849 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18850 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18851 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18852 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18853 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18854 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018855 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018856 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18857
18858 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18859 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18860 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18861 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18862 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18863 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018864 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018865 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18866 occurs.
18867
18868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188698.2.3. HTTP log format
18870----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018871
18872The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18873is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18874the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18875are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18876emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18877generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18878"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18879which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018880frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18881is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018882
18883Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18884slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18885with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18886
18887 Example :
18888 frontend http-in
18889 mode http
18890 option httplog
18891 log global
18892 default_backend bck
18893
18894 backend static
18895 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18896
18897 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18898 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18899 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018900 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018901
18902 Field Format Extract from the example above
18903 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18904 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018905 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018906 4 frontend_name http-in
18907 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018908 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018909 7 status_code 200
18910 8 bytes_read* 2750
18911 9 captured_request_cookie -
18912 10 captured_response_cookie -
18913 11 termination_state ----
18914 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18915 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18916 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18917 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18918 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018919
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018920Detailed fields description :
18921 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018922 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18923 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18924 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018925 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018926 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018927 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018928
18929 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018930 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18931 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18932 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018933
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018934 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18935 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018936
18937 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18938 and processed the connection.
18939
18940 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18941 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18942 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18943
18944 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18945 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18946 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18947 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18948 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18949 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18950
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018951 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18952 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18953 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018954 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018955 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18956 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018957 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18958 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018959
18960 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18961 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018962 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018963
18964 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18965 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018966 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18967 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018968
18969 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18970 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18971 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18972 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18973 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018974 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18975 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018976
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018977 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18978 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18979 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18980 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18981 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18982 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18983 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018984 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018985
18986 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18987 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18988 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18989
18990 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18991 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018992 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018993 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18994 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18995 overflowing.
18996
18997 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18998 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18999 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19000 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19001 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19002 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19003 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19004 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19005
19006 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19007 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19008 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19009 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19010 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19011 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19012 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19013 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19014
19015 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19016 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19017 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19018 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19019 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19020 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19021 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19022
19023 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019024 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019025 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19026 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19027 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019028 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019029 system.
19030
19031 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19032 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19033 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19034 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19035 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19036 caused by a denial of service attack.
19037
19038 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19039 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19040 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19041 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19042 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19043 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19044 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19045 denial of service attack.
19046
19047 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19048 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19049 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19050 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19051 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19052 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19053 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19054 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19055 processed than on other servers.
19056
19057 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19058 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19059 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19060 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19061 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19062 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19063 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19064 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19065 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19066 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19067 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19068 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19069 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19070
19071 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19072 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19073 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19074 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19075 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19076 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019077 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019078 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19079
19080 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19081 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19082 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19083 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19084 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19085 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019086 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019087 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19088 occurs.
19089
19090 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19091 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19092 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19093 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19094 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19095 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19096 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19097 cookies" below for more details.
19098
19099 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19100 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19101 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19102 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19103 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19104 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19105 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19106 and cookies" below for more details.
19107
19108 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19109 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19110 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19111 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19112 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19113 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19114 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19115 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19116
19117
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200191188.2.4. Custom log format
19119------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019120
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019121The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019122mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019123
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019124HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019125Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19126separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19127prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19128
19129Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19130variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019131("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019132
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019133If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019134as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019135less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19136the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19137
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019138Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19139"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19140delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19141preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019142
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019143Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19144'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19145https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19146such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19147
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019148Flags are :
19149 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019150 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019151 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19152 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019153
19154 Example:
19155
19156 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19157 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19158
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019159 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19160
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019161At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19162
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019163 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19164 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019165
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019166the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019167
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019168 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19169 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19170 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019171
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019172and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19173
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019174 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19175 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019176
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019177Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19178
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019179 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019180 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019181 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19182 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19183 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019184 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19185 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19186 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019187 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019188 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19189 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019190 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019191 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19192 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019193 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019194 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019195 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019196 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019197 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019198 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019199 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019200 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19201 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19202 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19203 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19204 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019205 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019206 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019207 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019208 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019209 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019210 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19211 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019212 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19213 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19214 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019215 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019216 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19217 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019218 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019219 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19220 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19221 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019222 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019223 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019224 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19225 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19226 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19227 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019228 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019229 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019230 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019231 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019232 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019233 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019234 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19235 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19236 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019237 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019238 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19239 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019240 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019241 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19242 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019243 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019244 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019245 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019246 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019247
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019248 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019249
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019250
192518.2.5. Error log format
19252-----------------------
19253
19254When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19255protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19256By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19257"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019258will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019259logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19260
19261The format looks like this :
19262
19263 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19264 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19265 Connection error during SSL handshake
19266
19267 Field Format Extract from the example above
19268 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19269 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19270 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19271 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19272 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19273
19274These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19275failures.
19276
19277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192788.3. Advanced logging options
19279-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019280
19281Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19282just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19283options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19284for more information about their usage.
19285
19286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192878.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19288------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019289
19290It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19291haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19292commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19293monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19294ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19295
19296 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19297 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19298 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19299 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19300
19301 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
19302 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
19303 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019304 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019305 such as other load-balancers.
19306
19307 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19308 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19309 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19310
19311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193128.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19313----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019314
19315The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19316what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19317or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019318"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019319just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19320log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19321after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19322is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19323with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19324with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19325
19326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193278.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19328------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019329
19330Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19331for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19332"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19333retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19334raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19335a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19336file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19337you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19338"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19339
19340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193418.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19342--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019343
19344Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19345multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19346them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19347"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19348logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19349error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19350and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19351too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19352useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19353alternative.
19354
19355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193568.4. Timing events
19357------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019358
19359Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19360reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19361the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19362frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019363mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19364addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19365
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019366Timings events in HTTP mode:
19367
19368 first request 2nd request
19369 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19370 t tr t tr ...
19371 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19372 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19373 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19374 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019375 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019376 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19377
19378Timings events in TCP mode:
19379
19380 TCP session
19381 |<----------------->|
19382 t t
19383 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19384 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19385 |<------ Tt ------->|
19386
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019387 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019388 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019389 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19390 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19391 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019392 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019393 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19394 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19395 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19396 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019397
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019398 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19399 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19400 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019401 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19402 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19403 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19404 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19405 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19406 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019407
19408 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19409 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19410 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19411 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19412 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19413 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19414 request typed by hand during a test.
19415
19416 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19417 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019418 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019419 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19420 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19421 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19422 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019423
19424 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19425 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19426 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19427 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19428 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19429
19430 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19431 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19432 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19433 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19434 connection never established.
19435
19436 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19437 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19438 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19439 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19440 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19441 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19442 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19443 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19444 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19445 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19446 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19447
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019448 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19449 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19450 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19451 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19452 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19453 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19454
19455 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19456
19457 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19458 "Ta" can never be negative.
19459
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019460 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19461 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019462 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19463 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019464 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019465
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019466 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019467
19468 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019469 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19470 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019471
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019472 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19473 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19474 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19475 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19476 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19477 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19478 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19479 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19480
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019481These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19482protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19483that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019484due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19485"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19486that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019487
19488Most common cases :
19489
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019490 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19491 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19492 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19493 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19494 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19495 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19496 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19497 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19498 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19499 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19500 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019501 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019502
19503 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19504 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19505 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19506 of ms on remote networks.
19507
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019508 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19509 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19510 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019511
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019512 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19513 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19514 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19515 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19516 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19517 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19518 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19519 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19520 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019521
19522Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19523
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019524 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019525 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019526 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019527
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019528 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019529 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19530 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19531
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019532 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019533 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19534 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19535 flags.
19536
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019537 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19538 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019539 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19540 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19541 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19542 the client connection was maintained open.
19543
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019544 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019545 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019546 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019547 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19548
19549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195508.5. Session state at disconnection
19551-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019552
19553TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19554"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
195552-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19556each of which has a special meaning :
19557
19558 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19559 session to terminate :
19560
19561 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19562
19563 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19564 server explicitly refused it.
19565
19566 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19567 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19568 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19569 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019570 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019571
19572 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19573 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019574
19575 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19576 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19577 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19578 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19579 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19580
19581 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19582 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19583 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19584 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19585 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19586
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019587 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19588 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19589
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019590 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19591 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19592 backup connections when going up.
19593
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019594 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19595
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019596 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19597 send or receive data.
19598
19599 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19600 send or receive data.
19601
19602 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19603 with nothing left in the buffers.
19604
19605 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19606
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019607 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019608 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19609
19610 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19611 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19612 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19613 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19614 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19615
19616 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19617 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19618
19619 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19620 server (HTTP only).
19621
19622 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19623
19624 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19625 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19626 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19627
19628 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19629 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19630 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19631
19632 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19633
19634 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19635 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19636
19637 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19638 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19639 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19640
19641 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19642 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019643 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19644 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019645
19646 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19647 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19648 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19649 another server.
19650
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019651 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019652 server.
19653
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019654 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19655 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19656 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19657 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19658
19659 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19660 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19661 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19662 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19663
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019664 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19665 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19666 "use-server" rule).
19667
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019668 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19669
19670 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19671 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19672
19673 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19674
19675 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19676 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19677 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19678
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019679 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19680 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019681 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019682 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19683 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19684
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019685 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19686
19687 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19688 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19689
19690 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19691
19692 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19693
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019694The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19695was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019696helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19697starvation, attacks, etc...
19698
19699The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19700alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19701easier finding and understanding.
19702
19703 Flags Reason
19704
19705 -- Normal termination.
19706
19707 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19708 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19709 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19710 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19711
19712 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19713 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19714 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19715 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19716 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19717 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019718
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019719 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19720 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019721 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019722
19723 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19724 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19725 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19726
19727 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19728 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19729 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19730 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19731 the server takes too long to respond.
19732
19733 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19734 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19735 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19736 long a time to respond.
19737
19738 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19739 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19740 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19741 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019742 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19743 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019744
19745 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19746 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19747 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19748 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19749 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019750 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019751 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19752 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19753 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19754 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19755 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19756 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19757 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19758 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019759 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019760 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19761 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19762 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019763
19764 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19765 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019766 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19767 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19768 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19769 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019770
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019771 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19772 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019774 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019775 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19776 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019777 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019778 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19779 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19780
19781 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19782 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19783 503 or 504 here.
19784
19785 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19786 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19787 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19788 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19789 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19790
19791 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19792 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019793 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019794 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19795 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19796
19797 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19798 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19799 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19800 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19801 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19802 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19803 between haproxy and the server.
19804
19805 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19806 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19807 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19808 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19809 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19810 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19811 solution is to fix the application.
19812
19813 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19814 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19815 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19816 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19817 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19818 external attacks.
19819
19820 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19821 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019822 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019823 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19824 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19825
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019826 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19827 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19828 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019829 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019830 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019831
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019832 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19833 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19834 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19835 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019836 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19837 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19838 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19839 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19840 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019841
19842 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19843 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19844 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19845 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19846
19847 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19848 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19849 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19850 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19851
19852 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19853 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19854 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19855 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19856
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019857The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19858persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19859important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19860re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19861
19862 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19863
19864 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19865 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19866 set on a GET request.
19867
19868 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19869 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019870 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019871 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19872
19873 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19874 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19875 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19876
19877 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19878 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19879 already got a cookie.
19880
19881 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19882 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19883 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19884 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19885 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19886
19887 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19888 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19889 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19890
19891 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19892 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19893 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19894
19895 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19896 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19897
19898 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19899 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19900 then advertised in the response.
19901
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199038.6. Non-printable characters
19904-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019905
19906In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19907consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19908converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19909prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19910being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19911escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19912is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19913'}' when logging headers.
19914
19915Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19916issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19917containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19918
19919Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19920the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19921performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19922
19923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199248.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19925---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019926
19927Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19928achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019929section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019930cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19931the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19932the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019933locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019934not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19935user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19936a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19937wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19938
19939 Examples :
19940 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19941 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19942
19943 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19944 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19945
19946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199478.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19948---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019949
19950Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19951proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19952the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19953server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19954
19955Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19956response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019957section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019958
19959It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019960time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19961appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019962are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19963and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19964follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19965request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19966in the logs.
19967
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019968As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19969frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19970an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19971
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019972 Example :
19973 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19974 listen proxy-out
19975 mode http
19976 option httplog
19977 option logasap
19978 log global
19979 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19980
19981 # log the name of the virtual server
19982 capture request header Host len 20
19983
19984 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19985 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19986
19987 # log the beginning of the referrer
19988 capture request header Referer len 20
19989
19990 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19991 capture response header Server len 20
19992
19993 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19994 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19995
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019996 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019997 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19998
19999 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20000 capture response header Via len 20
20001
20002 # log the URL location during a redirection
20003 capture response header Location len 20
20004
20005 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20006 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20007 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20008 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20009 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20010
20011 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20012 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20013 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20014 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020015 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020016
20017 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20018 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20019 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20020 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20021 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020022 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020023
20024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200258.9. Examples of logs
20026---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020027
20028These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20029them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20030reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20031
20032 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20033 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20034 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20035
20036 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20037 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20038
20039 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20040 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20041 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20042
20043 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20044 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20045
20046 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20047 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20048 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20049
20050 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020051 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020052 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20053 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20054
20055 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20056 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20057 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20058
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020059 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20060 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20061 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20062 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20063 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20064 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020065
20066 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020067 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020068
20069 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20070 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20071 Nothing was sent to any server.
20072
20073 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20074 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20075
20076 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20077 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020078 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020079 send a 408 return code to the client.
20080
20081 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20082 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20083
20084 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20085 5 seconds ("c----").
20086
20087 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20088 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020089 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020090
20091 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020092 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020093 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20094 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20095 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20096 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20097 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020098
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020099
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200201009. Supported filters
20101--------------------
20102
20103Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20104accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20105unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20106
20107See also : "filter"
20108
201099.1. Trace
20110----------
20111
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020112filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020113
20114 Arguments:
20115 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20116 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20117
20118 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20119 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20120 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20121 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20122
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020123 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020124 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20125 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20126 amount of the parsed data.
20127
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020128 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020129
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020130This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20131callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20132information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20133filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20134
20135Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20136tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20137a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20138
20139
201409.2. HTTP compression
20141---------------------
20142
20143filter compression
20144
20145The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20146keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020147when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20148fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20149done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20150explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20151filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20152listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20153order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020154
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020155See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20156 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020157
20158
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200201599.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20160--------------------------------------------
20161
20162filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20163
20164 Arguments :
20165
20166 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20167 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20168 parsed.
20169
20170 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20171 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20172 part must be placed in its own scope.
20173
20174The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20175external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020176streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020177exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20178also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20179
20180SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20181the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20182
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020183For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020184"doc/SPOE.txt".
20185
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100201869.4. Cache
20187----------
20188
20189filter cache <name>
20190
20191 Arguments :
20192
20193 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20194
20195The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20196"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020197cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020198other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20199case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20200is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20201filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020202listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20203order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020204
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020205See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20206 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20207
20208
202099.5. Fcgi-app
20210-------------
20211
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020212filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020213
20214 Arguments :
20215
20216 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20217
20218The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20219request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20220reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20221used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20222implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20223used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20224fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20225used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20226order.
20227
20228See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20229 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20230
20231
2023210. FastCGI applications
20233-------------------------
20234
20235HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20236feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20237the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20238FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20239servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20240FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20241backend.
20242
20243HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20244application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20245connection.
20246
2024710.1. Setup
20248-----------
20249
2025010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20251--------------------------
20252
20253fcgi-app <name>
20254 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20255 document root must be defined.
20256
20257acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20258 Declare or complete an access list.
20259
20260 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20261 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20262 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20263 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20264 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20265
20266docroot <path>
20267 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20268 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20269 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20270
20271index <script-name>
20272 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20273 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20274 is an optional setting.
20275
20276 Example :
20277 index index.php
20278
20279log-stderr global
20280log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20281 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20282 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20283
20284 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20285 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20286
20287pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20288 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20289 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20290 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20291
20292 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20293 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20294 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20295 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20296
20297 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20298 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20299
20300path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020301 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020302 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20303 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20304 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20305 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20306 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20307 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20308 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020309
20310 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020311 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020312 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20313 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20314 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20315 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020316
20317 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020318 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20319 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020320
20321option get-values
20322no option get-values
20323 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20324
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020325 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020326 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20327
20328 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20329 application will accept.
20330
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020331 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20332 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020333
20334 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020335 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020336 option is disabled.
20337
20338 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20339 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20340 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20341 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20342 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20343 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20344
20345option keep-conn
20346no option keep-conn
20347 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20348 sending a response.
20349
20350 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20351 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20352
20353option max-reqs <reqs>
20354 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20355 accept.
20356
20357 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20358 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20359 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20360 to 1.
20361
20362option mpxs-conns
20363no option mpxs-conns
20364 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20365
20366 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20367 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20368
20369set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20370 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20371 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20372 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20373 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20374
20375 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20376 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20377 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20378
20379 Example :
20380 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20381 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20382
20383 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20384
20385
2038610.1.2. Proxy section
20387---------------------
20388
20389use-fcgi-app <name>
20390 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20391
20392 Arguments :
20393 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20394
20395 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20396 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20397 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20398 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20399 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20400
20401 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20402 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20403 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20404 application are evaluated.
20405
20406
2040710.1.3. Example
20408---------------
20409
20410 frontend front-http
20411 mode http
20412 bind *:80
20413 bind *:
20414
20415 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20416 default_backend back-static
20417
20418 backend back-static
20419 mode http
20420 server www A.B.C.D:80
20421
20422 backend back-dynamic
20423 mode http
20424 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20425 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20426
20427 fcgi-app php-fpm
20428 log-stderr global
20429 option keep-conn
20430
20431 docroot /var/www/my-app
20432 index index.php
20433 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20434
20435
2043610.2. Default parameters
20437------------------------
20438
20439A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20440the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020441script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020442applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20443
20444 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20445 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20446 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20447 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20448 | | |
20449 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20450 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20451 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20452 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20453 | | application. |
20454 | | |
20455 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20456 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20457 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20458 | | |
20459 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20460 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20461 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20462 | | the application's configuration. |
20463 | | |
20464 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20465 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20466 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20467 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20468 | | |
20469 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20470 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20471 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20472 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20473 | | be defined. |
20474 | | |
20475 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20476 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20477 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20478 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20479 | | is not set too. |
20480 | | |
20481 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20482 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20483 | | set. |
20484 | | |
20485 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20486 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20487 | | the request. |
20488 | | |
20489 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20490 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20491 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20492 | | |
20493 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20494 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20495 | | script to process the request. |
20496 | | |
20497 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20498 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20499 | | |
20500 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20501 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20502 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20503 | | |
20504 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20505 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20506 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20507 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20508 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20509 | | |
20510 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20511 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20512 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20513 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20514 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20515 | | side. |
20516 | | |
20517 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20518 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20519 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20520 | | connected to. |
20521 | | |
20522 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20523 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20524 | | |
20525 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20526 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20527 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20528 | | |
20529 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20530
20531
2053210.3. Limitations
20533------------------
20534
20535The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20536way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20537during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20538establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20539application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20540or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20541message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20542these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20543and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20544
20545Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20546request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20547requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20548
20549About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20550into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20551fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20552"http-request" ones.
20553
20554Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20555FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20556processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20557must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20558here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020559
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020560/*
20561 * Local variables:
20562 * fill-column: 79
20563 * End:
20564 */